Mercurial > vim
annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 6091:7090d7f160f7
Update runtime files. Add vroom file support.
author | Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org> |
---|---|
date | Sat, 26 Jul 2014 13:40:44 +0200 |
parents | b8f703a4e55f |
children | 1bff71d20262 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
6091
7090d7f160f7
Update runtime files. Add vroom file support.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6032
diff
changeset
|
1 *options.txt* For Vim version 7.4. Last change: 2014 Jul 23 |
7 | 2 |
3 | |
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar | |
5 | |
6 | |
7 Options *options* | |
8 | |
9 1. Setting options |set-option| | |
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting| | |
11 3. Options summary |option-summary| | |
12 | |
13 For an overview of options see help.txt |option-list|. | |
14 | |
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to | |
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms: | |
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle* | |
18 number has a numeric value | |
19 string has a string value | |
20 | |
21 ============================================================================== | |
523 | 22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764* |
7 | 23 |
24 *:se* *:set* | |
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value. | |
26 | |
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options. | |
28 | |
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the | |
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated | |
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal | |
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either... | |
33 | |
34 *E518* *E519* | |
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}. | |
36 | |
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on. | |
38 Number option: show value. | |
39 String option: show value. | |
40 | |
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off. | |
42 | |
2152 | 43 *:set-!* *:set-inv* |
7 | 44 :se[t] {option}! or |
45 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi} | |
46 | |
47 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim* | |
48 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the | |
49 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi} | |
50 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi} | |
51 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi} | |
52 | |
53 :se[t] all& Set all options, except terminal options, to their | |
10 | 54 default value. The values of 'term', 'lines' and |
7 | 55 'columns' are not changed. {not in Vi} |
56 | |
57 *:set-args* *E487* *E521* | |
58 :se[t] {option}={value} or | |
59 :se[t] {option}:{value} | |
60 Set string or number option to {value}. | |
61 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal, | |
62 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0') | |
63 (hex and octal are only available for machines which | |
64 have the strtol() function). | |
65 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by | |
66 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is | |
67 set). See |cmdline-completion|. | |
68 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and | |
69 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value} | |
70 is not allowed. | |
71 See |option-backslash| for using white space and | |
72 backslashes in {value}. | |
73 | |
74 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=* | |
75 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the | |
76 {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
77 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
78 value was empty. | |
79 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags | |
557 | 80 are removed. When adding a flag that was already |
81 present the option value doesn't change. | |
809 | 82 Also see |:set-args| above. |
7 | 83 {not in Vi} |
84 | |
85 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=* | |
86 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend | |
87 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
88 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
89 value was empty. | |
90 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
91 {not in Vi} | |
92 | |
93 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=* | |
94 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove | |
95 the {value} from a string option, if it is there. | |
96 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there | |
97 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma | |
98 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option | |
99 becomes empty. | |
100 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be | |
101 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags | |
102 one by one to avoid problems. | |
103 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
104 {not in Vi} | |
105 | |
106 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: > | |
107 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3 | |
108 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given | |
109 and the following arguments will be ignored. | |
110 | |
111 *:set-verbose* | |
112 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it | |
113 was last set. Example: > | |
114 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent? | |
1621 | 115 < shiftwidth=4 ~ |
116 Last set from modeline ~ | |
117 cindent ~ | |
118 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim ~ | |
119 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose | |
120 set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument. | |
121 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message. | |
7 | 122 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or |
123 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported. | |
124 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting | |
125 'compatible'. | |
1621 | 126 A few special texts: |
127 Last set from modeline ~ | |
128 Option was set in a |modeline|. | |
129 Last set from --cmd argument ~ | |
130 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +. | |
131 Last set from -c argument ~ | |
132 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or | |
133 |-q|. | |
134 Last set from environment variable ~ | |
135 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT, | |
136 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT. | |
137 Last set from error handler ~ | |
138 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error. | |
139 | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
140 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature} |
7 | 141 |
142 *:set-termcap* *E522* | |
667 | 143 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will |
7 | 144 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If |
145 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: > | |
146 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot | |
147 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For | |
148 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: > | |
149 :set <M-b>=^[b | |
150 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it) | |
151 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations. | |
152 | |
2726 | 153 You can define any key codes, e.g.: > |
154 :set t_xy=^[foo; | |
155 There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these | |
156 codes as you like: > | |
157 :map <t_xy> something | |
158 < *E846* | |
159 When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its | |
160 value will result in an error: > | |
161 :set t_kb= | |
162 :set t_kb | |
163 E846: Key code not set: t_kb | |
164 | |
36 | 165 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
166 security reasons. | |
167 | |
7 | 168 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put |
10 | 169 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of |
7 | 170 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the |
171 |more-prompt|. | |
172 | |
173 *option-backslash* | |
174 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a | |
175 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this | |
176 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded | |
177 down). | |
178 A few examples: > | |
179 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags" | |
180 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file" | |
181 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file" | |
182 | |
10 | 183 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To |
184 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the | |
7 | 185 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": > |
186 :set titlestring=hi\|there | |
187 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": > | |
188 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there | |
189 | |
642 | 190 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in |
191 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring' | |
192 option to 'hi "there"': > | |
193 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\" | |
194 | |
10 | 195 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More |
7 | 196 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment |
197 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not | |
198 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma, | |
199 etc.) is used like explained above. | |
200 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": > | |
201 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
202 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
203 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!) | |
204 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes | |
205 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be | |
10 | 206 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a |
7 | 207 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it. |
208 | |
209 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags* | |
210 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552* | |
211 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an | |
212 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: > | |
213 :set guioptions+=a | |
214 Remove a flag from an option like this: > | |
215 :set guioptions-=a | |
216 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'. | |
10 | 217 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has |
7 | 218 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba" |
219 doesn't appear. | |
220 | |
221 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var* | |
22 | 222 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the |
7 | 223 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable |
224 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name | |
225 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may | |
226 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is | |
227 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: > | |
228 :set term=$TERM.new | |
229 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,. | |
230 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set | |
231 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing. | |
232 | |
233 | |
234 Handling of local options *local-options* | |
235 | |
236 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer | |
237 has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This | |
238 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set | |
239 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another. | |
240 | |
241 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific | |
242 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses | |
243 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user | |
244 expects is a bit complicated... | |
245 | |
246 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus | |
247 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same. | |
248 | |
249 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since | |
250 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer, | |
251 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a | |
252 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and | |
253 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed, | |
254 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer. | |
255 | |
256 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the last used window | |
257 options are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this window, the | |
258 values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the window where | |
259 the buffer was edited last are used. | |
260 | |
261 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer. | |
262 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep | |
263 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the | |
264 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window | |
265 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but | |
266 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: > | |
267 :e one | |
268 :set list | |
269 :e two | |
270 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list" | |
271 command you have also set the global value. > | |
272 :set nolist | |
273 :e one | |
274 :setlocal list | |
275 :e two | |
276 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global | |
277 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the | |
278 global value. Note that if you do this next: > | |
279 :e one | |
4358 | 280 You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one". |
281 The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also | |
282 happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is | |
283 wiped out |:bwipe|. | |
7 | 284 |
285 *:setl* *:setlocal* | |
286 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the | |
287 current buffer or window. Not all options have a | |
288 local value. If the option does not have a local | |
289 value the global value is set. | |
2413 | 290 With the "all" argument: display local values for all |
291 local options. | |
292 Without argument: Display local values for all local | |
293 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 294 When displaying a specific local option, show the |
1621 | 295 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when |
296 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed | |
297 before the option name. | |
298 For a global option the global value is | |
7 | 299 shown (but that might change in the future). |
300 {not in Vi} | |
301 | |
809 | 302 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by |
303 copying the value. | |
304 {not in Vi} | |
305 | |
3281 | 306 :se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of |
307 {option}, so that the global value will be used. | |
7 | 308 {not in Vi} |
309 | |
310 *:setg* *:setglobal* | |
311 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local | |
312 option without changing the local value. | |
313 When displaying an option, the global value is shown. | |
2413 | 314 With the "all" argument: display global values for all |
315 local options. | |
316 Without argument: display global values for all local | |
317 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 318 {not in Vi} |
319 | |
320 For buffer-local and window-local options: | |
321 Command global value local value ~ | |
322 :set option=value set set | |
323 :setlocal option=value - set | |
324 :setglobal option=value set - | |
325 :set option? - display | |
326 :setlocal option? - display | |
327 :setglobal option? display - | |
328 | |
329 | |
330 Global options with a local value *global-local* | |
331 | |
40 | 332 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows. |
333 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value. | |
334 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then | |
335 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global | |
336 value. | |
7 | 337 |
338 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global | |
339 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: > | |
340 :set makeprg=gmake | |
341 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set | |
342 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too. | |
343 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use | |
1152 | 344 another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source |
10 | 345 files. You use this command: > |
7 | 346 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake |
347 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: > | |
348 :setlocal makeprg= | |
349 This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the | |
350 "<" flag, like this: > | |
351 :setlocal autoread< | |
352 Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the | |
353 local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters | |
809 | 354 when the global value changes later). You can also use: > |
355 :set path< | |
356 This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is | |
357 used. Thus it does the same as: > | |
358 :setlocal path= | |
7 | 359 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using |
360 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then. | |
361 | |
362 | |
363 Setting the filetype | |
364 | |
365 :setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype* | |
366 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if | |
367 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands. | |
368 This is short for: > | |
369 :if !did_filetype() | |
370 : setlocal filetype={filetype} | |
371 :endif | |
372 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid | |
373 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different | |
374 settings and syntax files to be loaded. | |
375 {not in Vi} | |
376 | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
377 *option-window* *optwin* |
7 | 378 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options* |
379 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options. | |
380 Options are grouped by function. | |
381 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the | |
382 short help to open a help window with more help for | |
383 the option. | |
384 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the | |
385 "set" line to set the new value. For window and | |
386 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is | |
387 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help | |
388 window, in which case the window below help window is | |
389 used (skipping the option-window). | |
390 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or | |
391 |+autocmd| features} | |
392 | |
393 *$HOME* | |
394 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an | |
395 option and after a space or comma. | |
396 | |
397 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory | |
398 of user "user". Example: > | |
399 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,. | |
400 | |
401 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can | |
402 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the | |
403 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'. | |
404 | |
3224 | 405 On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then |
406 at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH. | |
407 | |
7 | 408 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set" |
409 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let". | |
410 | |
411 | |
412 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on | |
413 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. | |
414 | |
415 *:fix* *:fixdel* | |
416 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD': | |
417 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~ | |
418 CTRL-? CTRL-H | |
419 not CTRL-? CTRL-? | |
420 | |
421 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi} | |
422 | |
423 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the | |
424 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in | |
425 your .vimrc: > | |
426 :fixdel | |
427 < This works no matter what the actual code for | |
428 backspace is. | |
429 | |
430 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can | |
431 use this: > | |
432 :if &term == "termname" | |
433 : set t_kb=^V<BS> | |
434 : fixdel | |
435 :endif | |
436 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key | |
10 | 437 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname" |
7 | 438 with your terminal name. |
439 | |
440 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not | |
441 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: > | |
442 :if &term == "termname" | |
443 : set t_kD=^V<Delete> | |
444 :endif | |
445 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key | |
446 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname" | |
447 with your terminal name. | |
448 | |
449 *Linux-backspace* | |
450 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key | |
451 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by | |
452 putting this line in your rc.local: > | |
453 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys | |
454 < | |
455 *NetBSD-backspace* | |
456 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce | |
457 the right code, try this: > | |
458 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace" | |
459 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: > | |
460 keysym 22 = BackSpace | |
461 < You need to restart for this to take effect. | |
462 | |
463 ============================================================================== | |
464 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting* | |
465 | |
466 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives | |
467 to set options automatically for one or more files: | |
468 | |
469 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See | |
470 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions, | |
471 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started. | |
472 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and | |
473 |:mksession|. | |
474 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed. | |
475 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and | |
476 many other things. See |autocommand|. | |
477 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a | |
478 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for | |
479 modelines. This is explained here. | |
480 | |
481 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520* | |
482 There are two forms of modelines. The first form: | |
5055 | 483 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options} |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
484 |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
485 [text] any text or empty |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
486 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>) |
5055 | 487 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:" |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
488 [white] optional white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
489 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
490 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
491 for a ":set" command (can be empty) |
7 | 492 |
5055 | 493 Examples: |
782 | 494 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~ |
5055 | 495 vim: tw=77 ~ |
7 | 496 |
497 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi): | |
498 | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
499 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text] |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
500 |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
501 [text] any text or empty |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
502 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>) |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
503 {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:" |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
504 [white] optional white space |
5055 | 505 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When |
506 "Vim" is used it must be "set". | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
507 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
508 is the argument for a ":set" command |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
509 : a colon |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
510 [text] any text or empty |
7 | 511 |
5055 | 512 Examples: |
782 | 513 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
5055 | 514 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
7 | 515 |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
516 The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
517 chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
518 "vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
519 version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
520 could be short for "example:"). |
7 | 521 |
522 *modeline-local* | |
523 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the | |
11 | 524 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global |
525 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and | |
526 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result | |
527 depends on which one was opened last. | |
7 | 528 |
23 | 529 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options |
530 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local | |
531 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer | |
532 in another window. But window-local options will be set. | |
533 | |
7 | 534 *modeline-version* |
535 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
536 number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used: |
7 | 537 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later |
538 vim<{vers}: version before {vers} | |
539 vim={vers}: version {vers} | |
540 vim>{vers}: version after {vers} | |
541 {vers} is 600 for Vim 6.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor). | |
782 | 542 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 6.0 and later: |
543 /* vim600: set foldmethod=marker: */ ~ | |
544 To use a modeline for Vim before version 5.7: | |
545 /* vim<570: set sw=4: */ ~ | |
7 | 546 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":". |
547 | |
548 | |
549 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option. | |
550 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked. | |
551 | |
552 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line | |
782 | 553 like: |
554 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~ | |
555 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK: | |
556 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~ | |
7 | 557 |
558 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped. | |
559 | |
560 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The | |
782 | 561 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example: |
562 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~ | |
7 | 563 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the |
564 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:". | |
565 | |
566 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody | |
1111 | 567 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options |
568 can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when it's used the | |
1152 | 569 |sandbox| is effective. Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline |
1111 | 570 causes trouble. E.g., when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines |
571 are wrapped unexpectedly. So disable modelines before editing untrusted text. | |
572 The mail ftplugin does this, for example. | |
7 | 573 |
574 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could | |
575 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For | |
576 example: > | |
577 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif | |
578 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing | |
579 "VAR". | |
580 | |
581 ============================================================================== | |
582 3. Options summary *option-summary* | |
583 | |
584 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with | |
585 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used. | |
586 | |
587 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option" | |
588 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used. | |
589 | |
590 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is | |
591 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when | |
592 'compatible' is set. | |
593 | |
594 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that | |
10 | 595 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a |
7 | 596 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in |
597 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view | |
598 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain | |
599 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example | |
600 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C | |
601 program. | |
602 | |
603 global one option for all buffers and windows | |
604 local to window each window has its own copy of this option | |
605 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option | |
606 | |
607 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window | |
608 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the | |
609 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the | |
610 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for | |
611 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is | |
10 | 612 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer |
613 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not | |
7 | 614 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the |
615 buffer is created. | |
616 | |
519 | 617 Hidden options *hidden-options* |
618 | |
619 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported | |
620 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces | |
621 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an | |
622 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden | |
623 option though, it is not stored. | |
624 | |
625 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: > | |
626 if exists('&foo') | |
627 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really | |
628 supported use something like this: > | |
629 if exists('+foo') | |
630 < | |
7 | 631 *E355* |
632 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|. | |
633 | |
634 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph* | |
635 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise) | |
636 global | |
637 {not in Vi} | |
638 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
639 feature} | |
640 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The | |
641 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode | |
642 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_) | |
643 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26]. | |
644 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8. | |
645 See |rileft.txt|. | |
646 | |
647 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'* | |
648 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off) | |
649 global | |
650 {not in Vi} | |
651 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
652 feature} | |
653 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to | |
654 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get | |
655 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See | |
656 'revins'. | |
657 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
658 | |
659 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'* | |
660 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off) | |
661 global | |
662 {not in Vi} | |
663 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi| | |
664 feature} | |
233 | 665 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles |
7 | 666 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set. |
667 | |
233 | 668 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This |
7 | 669 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right |
670 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left | |
10 | 671 mode). See |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 672 |
673 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'* | |
674 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single") | |
675 global | |
676 {not in Vi} | |
677 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
678 feature} | |
679 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding. | |
680 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class | |
681 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek | |
682 letters, Cyrillic letters). | |
683 | |
684 There are currently two possible values: | |
233 | 685 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is |
7 | 686 expected by most users. |
687 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters. | |
2492
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
688 *E834* *E835* |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
689 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars' |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
690 contains a character that would be double width. |
7 | 691 |
692 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for | |
693 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in | |
694 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro, | |
695 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets, | |
233 | 696 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also |
7 | 697 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text |
233 | 698 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or |
7 | 699 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font |
700 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.), | |
701 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived | |
702 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has | |
703 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP | |
704 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode | |
705 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11). | |
706 | |
4229 | 707 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is |
708 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the | |
4264 | 709 escape sequence to request cursor position report. |
4229 | 710 |
7 | 711 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'* |
712 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off) | |
713 global | |
714 {not in Vi} | |
715 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled | |
716 on Mac OS X} | |
717 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X | |
718 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts, | |
719 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays. | |
720 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set | |
721 to its default (empty string). | |
722 | |
723 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'* | |
724 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off) | |
725 global | |
726 {not in Vi} | |
2152 | 727 {only available when compiled with it, use |
728 exists("+autochdir") to check} | |
438 | 729 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you |
730 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window. | |
731 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened | |
732 or selected. | |
733 This option is provided for backward compatibility with the Vim | |
734 released with Sun ONE Studio 4 Enterprise Edition. | |
819 | 735 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work. |
7 | 736 |
737 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'* | |
738 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off) | |
739 local to window | |
740 {not in Vi} | |
741 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
742 feature} | |
743 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text. | |
744 Setting this option will: | |
745 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
746 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
747 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles | |
748 between typing English and Arabic key mapping. | |
749 - Set the 'delcombine' option | |
750 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text. | |
751 | |
752 Resetting this option will: | |
753 - Reset the 'rightleft' option. | |
754 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value). | |
755 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global | |
3557 | 756 option). |
7 | 757 Also see |arabic.txt|. |
758 | |
759 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'* | |
760 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'* | |
761 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on) | |
762 global | |
763 {not in Vi} | |
764 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
765 feature} | |
766 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character | |
767 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language | |
3893 | 768 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad |
7 | 769 one which encompasses: |
770 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location | |
771 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone). | |
772 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters | |
773 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
774 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
775 form. |
7 | 776 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for |
777 further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
778 | |
779 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'* | |
780 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off) | |
781 local to buffer | |
782 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR> | |
783 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not | |
784 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type | |
1152 | 785 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor |
786 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included | |
787 in 'cpoptions'. | |
10 | 788 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you |
789 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first | |
790 line. | |
7 | 791 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in |
792 a different way. | |
793 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set. | |
794 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing | |
795 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the | |
796 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}. | |
797 | |
798 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'* | |
799 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off) | |
800 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
801 {not in Vi} | |
802 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and | |
803 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again. | |
804 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp| | |
805 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to | |
806 using the global value: > | |
807 :set autoread< | |
808 < | |
809 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'* | |
810 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off) | |
811 global | |
812 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each | |
813 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!, | |
864 | 814 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I, |
7 | 815 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file. |
816 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see | |
817 'autowriteall' for that. | |
818 | |
819 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'* | |
820 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off) | |
821 global | |
822 {not in Vi} | |
823 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit", | |
824 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window. | |
825 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has | |
826 been set. | |
827 | |
828 *'background'* *'bg'* | |
2826 | 829 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below) |
7 | 830 global |
831 {not in Vi} | |
832 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a | |
833 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that | |
834 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal. | |
835 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used. | |
836 This will not always be correct. | |
837 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim | |
838 what the background color looks like. For changing the background | |
839 color, see |:hi-normal|. | |
840 | |
841 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for | |
10 | 842 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not |
1621 | 843 change. *g:colors_name* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
844 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set) |
7 | 845 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If |
846 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work. | |
847 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
848 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed. |
7 | 849 |
850 When setting 'background' to the default value with: > | |
851 :set background& | |
852 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly, | |
853 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value. | |
854 | |
855 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be | |
856 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects | |
857 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to | |
858 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read | |
859 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background | |
860 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by | |
861 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value | |
862 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on"). | |
2826 | 863 |
864 For MS-DOS, Windows and OS/2 the default is "dark". | |
865 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux", | |
866 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark | |
867 background. Otherwise the default is "light". | |
868 | |
7 | 869 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly |
870 depending on the terminal name. Example: > | |
871 :if &term == "pcterm" | |
872 : set background=dark | |
873 :endif | |
874 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups | |
875 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER | |
876 the setting of the 'background' option. | |
877 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file | |
878 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this | |
879 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be | |
880 done with ":syntax on". | |
881 | |
882 *'backspace'* *'bs'* | |
883 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "") | |
884 global | |
885 {not in Vi} | |
886 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert | |
887 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows | |
888 a way to backspace over something: | |
889 value effect ~ | |
890 indent allow backspacing over autoindent | |
891 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines) | |
892 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U | |
893 stop once at the start of insert. | |
894 | |
895 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used. | |
896 | |
897 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier: | |
898 value effect ~ | |
899 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible) | |
900 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol" | |
901 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start" | |
902 | |
903 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want. | |
904 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. | |
905 | |
906 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'* | |
907 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off) | |
908 global | |
909 {not in Vi} | |
910 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the | |
911 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the | |
912 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being | |
913 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is | |
914 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both | |
10 | 915 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the |
7 | 916 |backup-table| for more explanations. |
917 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. | |
918 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the | |
919 oldest version of a file. | |
920 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
921 | |
922 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'* | |
923 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto") | |
924 global | |
925 {not in Vi} | |
926 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's | |
927 done. This is a comma separated list of words. | |
928 | |
929 The main values are: | |
930 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one | |
931 "no" rename the file and write a new one | |
932 "auto" one of the previous, what works best | |
933 | |
934 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are: | |
935 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing | |
936 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing | |
937 | |
938 Making a copy and overwriting the original file: | |
939 - Takes extra time to copy the file. | |
940 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or | |
941 has a resource fork, all this is preserved. | |
942 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link, | |
943 not of the real file. | |
944 | |
945 Renaming the file and writing a new one: | |
946 + It's fast. | |
947 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new | |
948 file. | |
949 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link. | |
950 | |
951 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file | |
952 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and | |
1152 | 953 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a |
954 copy will be made. | |
7 | 955 |
956 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in | |
957 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they | |
958 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing | |
959 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to | |
960 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be | |
961 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or | |
962 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not | |
963 be propagated back to the original source. | |
964 *crontab* | |
965 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program | |
966 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if | |
967 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the | |
10 | 968 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an |
7 | 969 example. |
970 | |
971 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled | |
972 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and | |
973 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file | |
10 | 974 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The |
7 | 975 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this |
976 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for | |
977 others. | |
978 | |
979 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has | |
980 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file | |
981 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic) | |
982 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't | |
983 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly | |
984 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but | |
985 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will | |
986 again not rename the file. | |
987 | |
988 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'* | |
989 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
5555 | 990 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp" |
7 | 991 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/") |
992 global | |
993 {not in Vi} | |
994 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas. | |
995 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
996 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
997 create it for you. |
4186 | 998 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ( 'patchmode' is |
7 | 999 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this. |
1000 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory | |
1001 as the edited file. | |
33 | 1002 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to |
7 | 1003 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The |
1004 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
1005 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning). | |
1006 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part | |
1007 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
1008 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
1009 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
1010 - A directory name may end in an '/'. | |
1011 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
1012 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
1013 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
1014 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
1015 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
1016 of the option is removed. | |
1017 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options. | |
1018 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: > | |
1019 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp | |
1020 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your | |
1021 home directory for this to work properly. | |
1022 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
1023 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
1024 uses another default. | |
1025 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1026 security reasons. | |
1027 | |
1028 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589* | |
1029 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_") | |
1030 global | |
1031 {not in Vi} | |
1032 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the | |
1033 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids | |
1034 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might | |
1035 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with | |
1036 ".bak" that you want to keep. | |
36 | 1037 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 1038 |
26 | 1039 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre |
1040 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to | |
1041 include a timestamp. > | |
1042 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~' | |
1043 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory. | |
1044 | |
7 | 1045 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'* |
1046 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*") | |
1047 global | |
1048 {not in Vi} | |
1049 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
1050 feature} | |
1051 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the | |
1052 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both | |
1053 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used. | |
1054 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. | |
1055 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|. | |
1056 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the | |
233 | 1057 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix. |
1152 | 1058 |
3513 | 1059 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write |
1060 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
1061 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable | |
1062 backups if you don't care about losing the file. | |
1063 | |
1152 | 1064 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use |
1065 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: > | |
1066 :let backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*' | |
1067 | |
1068 < Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a | |
557 | 1069 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see |
1070 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|. | |
7 | 1071 |
1072 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'* | |
1073 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600) | |
1074 global | |
1075 {not in Vi} | |
1076 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
1077 feature} | |
1078 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|. | |
1079 | |
1080 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'* | |
1081 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off) | |
1082 global | |
1083 {not in Vi} | |
1084 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
189 | 1085 feature} |
7 | 1086 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality. |
1087 | |
189 | 1088 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'* |
1089 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "") | |
790 | 1090 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
189 | 1091 {not in Vi} |
1092 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
1093 feature} | |
782 | 1094 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used |
1095 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used: | |
189 | 1096 |
1097 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show | |
1098 v:beval_winnr number of the window | |
1099 v:beval_lnum line number | |
1100 v:beval_col column number (byte index) | |
1101 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer | |
1102 | |
1103 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! | |
1104 Example: > | |
1105 function! MyBalloonExpr() | |
435 | 1106 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum . |
189 | 1107 \', column ' . v:beval_col . |
1108 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) . | |
1109 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"' | |
1110 endfunction | |
1111 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr() | |
1112 set ballooneval | |
1113 < | |
1114 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text | |
1115 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty, | |
1116 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans | |
1117 or Sun Workshop). | |
1118 | |
3682 | 1119 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
1120 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 1121 |
1122 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
1123 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|. | |
1124 | |
446 | 1125 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: > |
435 | 1126 if has("balloon_multiline") |
714 | 1127 < When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the |
1128 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item | |
1129 as a string and putting "\n" in between them. | |
1130 | |
7 | 1131 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'* |
1132 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off) | |
1133 local to buffer | |
1134 {not in Vi} | |
1135 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also | |
1136 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few | |
1137 options will be changed (also when it already was on): | |
1138 'textwidth' will be set to 0 | |
1139 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0 | |
1140 'modeline' will be off | |
1141 'expandtab' will be off | |
1142 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the | |
1143 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL> | |
1144 separates lines). | |
1145 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the | |
1146 file is read without conversion. | |
1147 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is | |
1148 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g., | |
1149 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set | |
1150 'bin' again when the file has been loaded. | |
1151 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when | |
1152 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of | |
1153 saved option values. | |
1154 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument. | |
1155 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all | |
1156 files you edit. | |
1157 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if | |
1158 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to | |
1159 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See | |
1160 the 'endofline' option. | |
1161 | |
1162 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'* | |
1163 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on) | |
1164 global | |
1165 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS} | |
446 | 1166 When on the BIOS is called to obtain a keyboard character. This works |
7 | 1167 better to detect CTRL-C, but only works for the console. When using a |
1168 terminal over a serial port reset this option. | |
1169 Also see |'conskey'|. | |
1170 | |
1171 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'* | |
1172 'bomb' boolean (default off) | |
1173 local to buffer | |
1174 {not in Vi} | |
1175 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
1176 feature} | |
1177 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte | |
1178 Order Mark) is prepended to the file: | |
1179 - this option is on | |
1180 - the 'binary' option is off | |
1181 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big | |
1182 endian variants. | |
1183 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file. | |
1184 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it | |
1185 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1186 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM. |
7 | 1187 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a |
1188 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly. | |
1189 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you | |
1190 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM | |
1191 will be restored when writing the file. | |
1192 | |
1193 *'breakat'* *'brk'* | |
1194 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?") | |
1195 global | |
1196 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1197 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 1198 feature} |
1199 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line | |
500 | 1200 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit |
1201 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding. | |
7 | 1202 |
6009 | 1203 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* |
1204 'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off) | |
1205 local to window | |
1206 {not in Vi} | |
1207 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1208 feature} | |
1209 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of | |
1210 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks | |
1211 of text. | |
1212 | |
1213 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'* | |
1214 'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty) | |
1215 local to window | |
1216 {not in Vi} | |
1217 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1218 feature} | |
1219 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional | |
6026 | 1220 items and must be separated by a comma: |
6009 | 1221 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after |
1222 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting | |
1223 text should normally be narrower. This prevents | |
1224 text indented almost to the right window border | |
1225 occupying lot of vertical space when broken. | |
6026 | 1226 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's |
1227 beginning will be shifted by the given number of | |
1228 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph | |
6009 | 1229 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line |
1230 continuation (positive). | |
1231 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the | |
1232 additional indent. | |
1233 The default value for min is 20 and shift is 0. | |
1234 | |
7 | 1235 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'* |
29 | 1236 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last") |
7 | 1237 global |
1621 | 1238 {not in Vi} {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and |
1239 Win32 GUI} | |
7 | 1240 Which directory to use for the file browser: |
1621 | 1241 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
1242 file was opened or saved. |
7 | 1243 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer. |
1244 current Use the current directory. | |
1245 {path} Use the specified directory | |
1246 | |
1247 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'* | |
1248 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "") | |
1249 local to buffer | |
1250 {not in Vi} | |
1251 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
1252 feature} | |
1253 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer | |
1254 displayed in a window: | |
1255 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option | |
1256 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden' | |
1257 is not set | |
1258 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using | |
1259 |:hide| | |
1260 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1261 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1262 |:bdelete| | |
1263 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1264 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1265 |:bwipeout| | |
1266 | |
82 | 1267 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer |
3224 | 1268 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands |
1269 that switch between buffers temporarily. | |
7 | 1270 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify |
1271 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1272 | |
1273 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85* | |
1274 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on) | |
1275 local to buffer | |
1276 {not in Vi} | |
1277 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If | |
1278 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc. | |
1279 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember | |
1280 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer. | |
1281 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer". | |
1282 | |
1283 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382* | |
1284 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "") | |
1285 local to buffer | |
1286 {not in Vi} | |
1287 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
1288 feature} | |
1289 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer: | |
1290 <empty> normal buffer | |
1291 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be | |
1292 written | |
1293 nowrite buffer which will not be written | |
17 | 1294 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd |
856 | 1295 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the |
17 | 1296 |+autocmd| feature} |
7 | 1297 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow| |
648 | 1298 or list of locations |:lwindow| |
7 | 1299 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this |
1300 manually) | |
1301 | |
1302 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to | |
1303 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1304 | |
1305 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects! | |
1306 | |
648 | 1307 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location |
1308 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and | |
1309 you are not supposed to change it. | |
7 | 1310 |
1311 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar: | |
1312 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't | |
1313 work (":w filename" does work though). | |
1314 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|. | |
1315 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for | |
1316 example when you quit Vim. | |
1317 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory | |
1318 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap | |
1319 file). | |
1320 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a | |
1321 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd| | |
1322 command. | |
17 | 1323 *E676* |
1324 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like | |
1325 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and | |
1326 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned | |
1327 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|, | |
1328 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands. | |
7 | 1329 |
1330 *'casemap'* *'cmp'* | |
1331 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii") | |
1332 global | |
1333 {not in Vi} | |
804 | 1334 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| |
1335 feature} | |
7 | 1336 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain |
1337 these words, separated by a comma: | |
1338 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current | |
1339 locale does not change the case mapping. This only | |
493 | 1340 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding, |
1341 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is | |
1342 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library | |
1343 functions are used when available. | |
7 | 1344 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US |
1345 case mapping, the current locale is not effective. | |
1346 This probably only matters for Turkish. | |
1347 | |
1348 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346* | |
1349 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,") | |
1350 global | |
1351 {not in Vi} | |
1352 {not available when compiled without the | |
1353 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
1354 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
1355 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched | |
1668 | 1356 for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with "/", "./" |
1357 or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then. | |
7 | 1358 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as |
1359 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|. | |
1360 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look | |
1361 in the current directory first. | |
1362 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include | |
1363 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to | |
1364 override it: > | |
1365 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g') | |
1366 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1367 security reasons. | |
1368 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names). | |
1369 | |
1370 *'cedit'* | |
1371 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F) | |
1372 global | |
1373 {not in Vi} | |
1374 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| | |
1375 feature} | |
1376 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window. | |
1377 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off. | |
1378 Only non-printable keys are allowed. | |
1379 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to | |
1380 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: > | |
1381 :set cedit=<C-Y> | |
1382 :set cedit=<Esc> | |
1383 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character. | |
1384 See |cmdwin|. | |
1385 | |
1386 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513* | |
1387 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "") | |
1388 global | |
1389 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1390 and |+eval| features} |
7 | 1391 {not in Vi} |
1392 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is | |
1393 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a | |
1394 different encoding from what is desired. | |
1395 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is | |
1396 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is | |
1397 preferred, because it is much faster. | |
1398 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no | |
1399 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first. | |
1400 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success, | |
1401 non-zero for failure. | |
1402 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'. | |
1403 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are | |
1404 used. | |
1405 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8" | |
1406 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this. | |
1407 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c' | |
1408 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion. | |
1409 Example: > | |
1410 set charconvert=CharConvert() | |
1411 fun CharConvert() | |
1412 system("recode " | |
1413 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to | |
1414 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out) | |
1415 return v:shell_error | |
1416 endfun | |
1417 < The related Vim variables are: | |
1418 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding | |
1419 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding | |
1420 v:fname_in name of the input file | |
1421 v:fname_out name of the output file | |
1422 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same. | |
1423 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different | |
1424 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4. | |
1425 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want | |
1426 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care | |
1427 of this. | |
1428 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1429 security reasons. | |
1430 | |
1431 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'* | |
1432 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off) | |
1433 local to buffer | |
1434 {not in Vi} | |
1435 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1436 feature} | |
1621 | 1437 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys |
7 | 1438 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your |
1439 preferred indent style. | |
1440 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'. | |
1441 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty, | |
1442 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an | |
1443 external program. | |
1444 See |C-indenting|. | |
1445 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent' | |
1446 option or 'indentexpr'. | |
1447 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
1448 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
1449 | |
1450 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'* | |
1451 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") | |
1452 local to buffer | |
1453 {not in Vi} | |
1454 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1455 feature} | |
1456 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
1457 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is | |
1458 empty. | |
1459 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|. | |
1460 See |C-indenting|. | |
1461 | |
1462 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'* | |
1463 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "") | |
1464 local to buffer | |
1465 {not in Vi} | |
1466 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1467 feature} | |
1468 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C | |
1469 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and | |
1470 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general. | |
1471 | |
1472 | |
1473 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'* | |
1474 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch") | |
1475 local to buffer | |
1476 {not in Vi} | |
1477 {not available when compiled without both the | |
1478 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features} | |
1479 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when | |
1480 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at | |
1481 an appropriate place (inside {}). | |
1482 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't | |
1483 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase: | |
1484 "if,If,IF". | |
1485 | |
1486 *'clipboard'* *'cb'* | |
1487 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux" | |
1488 for X-windows, "" otherwise) | |
1489 global | |
1490 {not in Vi} | |
1491 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard| | |
1492 feature is included} | |
1493 This option is a list of comma separated names. | |
1494 These names are recognized: | |
1495 | |
3674 | 1496 *clipboard-unnamed* |
7 | 1497 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*' |
1498 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which | |
1499 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a | |
1500 register is explicitly specified, it will always be | |
1501 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard' | |
1502 or not. The clipboard register can always be | |
1503 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see | |
1504 |gui-clipboard|. | |
1505 | |
3682 | 1506 *clipboard-unnamedplus* |
4119 | 1507 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the |
1508 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of | |
1509 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put | |
1510 operations which would normally go to the unnamed | |
1511 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the | |
1512 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or | |
1513 put) will additionally copy the text into register | |
1514 '*'. | |
2662 | 1515 Only available with the |+X11| feature. |
2654 | 1516 Availability can be checked with: > |
1517 if has('unnamedplus') | |
1518 < | |
3682 | 1519 *clipboard-autoselect* |
7 | 1520 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present, |
1521 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual | |
1522 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the | |
1523 windowing system's global selection or put the | |
1524 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection | |
1525 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for | |
1526 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in | |
1527 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this | |
1528 "autoselect" flag is used. | |
1529 Also applies to the modeless selection. | |
1530 | |
3674 | 1531 *clipboard-autoselectplus* |
1532 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of | |
1533 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in | |
1534 'guioptions'. | |
1535 | |
1536 *clipboard-autoselectml* | |
7 | 1537 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection |
1538 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
1539 | |
3674 | 1540 *clipboard-html* |
1904 | 1541 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when |
1542 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it | |
1543 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from | |
1544 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML | |
1545 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox. | |
2240
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1546 You probably want to add this only temporarily, |
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1547 possibly use BufEnter autocommands. |
1904 | 1548 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later. |
1549 Only available with the |+multi_byte| feature. | |
1550 | |
3674 | 1551 *clipboard-exclude* |
7 | 1552 exclude:{pattern} |
1553 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of | |
1554 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no | |
1555 connection will be made to the X server. This is | |
1556 useful in this situation: | |
1557 - Running Vim in a console. | |
1558 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another | |
1559 display. | |
1560 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the | |
1561 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator. | |
1562 To never connect to the X server use: > | |
1563 exclude:.* | |
1564 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument. | |
1565 Note that when there is no connection to the X server | |
1566 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard | |
1567 cannot be accessed. | |
1568 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is | |
1569 interpreted as if 'magic' was on. | |
1570 The rest of the option value will be used for | |
1571 {pattern}, this must be the last entry. | |
1572 | |
1573 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'* | |
1574 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1) | |
1575 global | |
1576 {not in Vi} | |
1577 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding | |
1578 |hit-enter| prompts. | |
824 | 1579 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab |
1580 page can have a different value. | |
7 | 1581 |
1582 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'* | |
1583 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7) | |
1584 global | |
1585 {not in Vi} | |
1586 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| | |
1587 feature} | |
1588 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin| | |
1589 | |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1590 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'* |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1591 'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "") |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1592 local to window |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1593 {not in Vi} |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1594 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1595 feature} |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1596 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1597 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1598 text. Will make screen redrawing slower. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1599 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1600 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. > |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1601 |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1602 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1603 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1604 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1605 < |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1606 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1607 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1608 |
7 | 1609 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594* |
1610 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width) | |
1611 global | |
1612 {not in Vi} | |
1613 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal | |
161 | 1614 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see |
1615 |posix-screen-size|. | |
7 | 1616 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
1617 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
1618 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
1619 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical | |
1152 | 1620 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For |
1621 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to | |
1622 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest | |
1623 window possible: > | |
1624 :set columns=9999 | |
1625 < Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000. | |
7 | 1626 |
1627 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525* | |
1628 'comments' 'com' string (default | |
1629 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-") | |
1630 local to buffer | |
1631 {not in Vi} | |
1632 {not available when compiled without the |+comments| | |
1633 feature} | |
1634 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See | |
1635 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to | |
1636 insert a space. | |
1637 | |
1638 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537* | |
1639 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/") | |
1640 local to buffer | |
1641 {not in Vi} | |
1642 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
1643 feature} | |
1644 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the | |
1645 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see | |
1646 |fold-marker|. | |
1647 | |
1648 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'* | |
819 | 1649 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| |
1650 file is found) | |
7 | 1651 global |
1652 {not in Vi} | |
1653 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or | |
1654 make Vim behave in a more useful way. | |
1655 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset, | |
1656 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or | |
1657 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings | |
10 | 1658 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you |
7 | 1659 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the |
1660 very start. | |
1661 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the | |
1662 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim | |
1663 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible' | |
1664 option. | |
819 | 1665 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up, |
378 | 1666 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been |
1667 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means | |
819 | 1668 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim |
378 | 1669 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't |
1152 | 1670 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given |
1671 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and | |
1672 |posix-compliance|. | |
7 | 1673 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with |
1674 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|. | |
1675 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options | |
1676 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options | |
1677 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified. | |
1678 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set | |
1679 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table | |
10 | 1680 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible |
7 | 1681 editing. |
1682 See also 'cpoptions'. | |
1683 | |
1684 option + set value effect ~ | |
1685 | |
1686 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command | |
1687 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy | |
1688 others: "auto" copy or rename backup file | |
1689 'backspace' "" normal backspace | |
1690 'backup' off no backup file | |
1691 'cindent' off no C code indentation | |
1692 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin| | |
1693 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags | |
1694 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag" | |
1695 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder| | |
1696 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose| | |
1697 'digraph' off no digraphs | |
1698 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode | |
1699 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces | |
1700 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection, | |
1701 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2 | |
1702 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting | |
1703 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s" | |
1704 'history' + 0 no commandline history | |
1705 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1706 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1707 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches | |
1708 'incsearch' off no incremental searching | |
1709 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression | |
1710 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode | |
1711 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric | |
1712 characters and '_' | |
1713 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period | |
1714 'modeline' + off no modelines | |
1715 'more' + off no pauses in listings | |
1716 'revins' off no reverse insert | |
1717 'ruler' off no ruler | |
1718 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll | |
1719 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset | |
1720 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth | |
1721 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages | |
1722 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown | |
1723 'showmode' + off current mode not shown | |
1724 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch | |
1725 'smartindent' off no smart indentation | |
1726 'smarttab' off no smart tab size | |
1727 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions | |
1728 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands | |
1729 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative | |
1730 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection | |
1731 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap | |
1732 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator | |
1733 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout | |
1734 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap | |
1735 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab> | |
1736 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1737 'writebackup' on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature |
7 | 1738 |
1739 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535* | |
1740 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i") | |
1741 local to buffer | |
1742 {not in Vi} | |
1743 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works | |
1744 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line | |
1745 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion | |
1746 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags: | |
4186 | 1747 . scan the current buffer ( 'wrapscan' is ignored) |
7 | 1748 w scan buffers from other windows |
1749 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1750 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1751 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list | |
1752 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option | |
703 | 1753 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell| |
7 | 1754 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given, |
1755 patterns are valid too. For example: > | |
1756 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish | |
1757 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option | |
1758 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns | |
1759 are valid too. | |
1760 i scan current and included files | |
1761 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro | |
1762 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D| | |
1763 ] tag completion | |
1764 t same as "]" | |
1765 | |
1766 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are | |
1767 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files | |
1768 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for | |
1769 whole-line completion. | |
1770 | |
1771 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan: | |
1772 1. the current buffer | |
1773 2. buffers in other windows | |
1774 3. other loaded buffers | |
1775 4. unloaded buffers | |
1776 5. tags | |
1777 6. included files | |
1778 | |
1779 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'- | |
233 | 1780 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns |
1781 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions). | |
7 | 1782 |
12 | 1783 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'* |
1784 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty) | |
1785 local to buffer | |
1786 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1787 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1788 or |+insert_expand| features} |
623 | 1789 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion |
1790 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U| | |
648 | 1791 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
1792 invoked and what it should return. | |
2642 | 1793 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
1794 security reasons. | |
14 | 1795 |
540 | 1796 *'completeopt'* *'cot'* |
730 | 1797 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview") |
540 | 1798 global |
766 | 1799 {not available when compiled without the |
1800 |+insert_expand| feature} | |
540 | 1801 {not in Vi} |
665 | 1802 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion |
1803 |ins-completion|. The supported values are: | |
540 | 1804 |
1805 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The | |
1806 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and | |
1807 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu| | |
1808 | |
707 | 1809 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match. |
856 | 1810 Useful when there is additional information about the |
707 | 1811 match, e.g., what file it comes from. |
1812 | |
836 | 1813 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If |
1814 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more | |
1815 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind | |
1816 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is | |
1817 used. | |
665 | 1818 |
730 | 1819 preview Show extra information about the currently selected |
1152 | 1820 completion in the preview window. Only works in |
1821 combination with "menu" or "menuone". | |
1822 | |
730 | 1823 |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1824 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'* |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1825 'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "") |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1826 local to window |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1827 {not in Vi} |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1828 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1829 feature} |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1830 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1831 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1832 other lines. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1833 n Normal mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1834 v Visual mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1835 i Insert mode |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1836 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch' |
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1837 |
2400
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2394
diff
changeset
|
1838 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor. |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1839 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1840 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1841 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1842 you can see what you are doing. |
2380
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1843 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's |
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1844 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column. |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1845 |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1846 |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1847 'conceallevel' 'cole' *'conceallevel'* *'cole'* |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1848 number (default 0) |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1849 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1850 {not in Vi} |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1851 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1852 feature} |
2340
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1853 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal| |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1854 is shown: |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1855 |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1856 Value Effect ~ |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1857 0 Text is shown normally |
2426 | 1858 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one |
1859 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom | |
1860 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the | |
1861 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a | |
1862 space). | |
1863 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group. | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1864 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1865 custom replacement character defined (see |
2426 | 1866 |:syn-cchar|). |
2349
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1867 3 Concealed text is completely hidden. |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1868 |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1869 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1870 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor' |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1871 option. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1872 |
7 | 1873 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'* |
1874 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off) | |
1875 global | |
1876 {not in Vi} | |
1877 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally | |
1878 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e", | |
1879 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current | |
1880 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer. | |
1881 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one | |
1882 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm| | |
1883 command. | |
1884 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
1885 | |
1886 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'* | |
1887 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off) | |
1888 global | |
1889 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS} | |
1890 When on direct console I/O is used to obtain a keyboard character. | |
10 | 1891 This should work in most cases. Also see |'bioskey'|. Together, |
7 | 1892 three methods of console input are available: |
1893 'conskey' 'bioskey' action ~ | |
1894 on on or off direct console input | |
1895 off on BIOS | |
1896 off off STDIN | |
1897 | |
1898 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'* | |
1899 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off) | |
1900 local to buffer | |
1901 {not in Vi} | |
1902 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a | |
1903 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of | |
1904 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled, | |
1905 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the | |
1906 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the | |
1621 | 1907 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab |
1908 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing | |
7 | 1909 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner. |
1910 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
1911 Also see 'preserveindent'. | |
1912 | |
1913 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* | |
1914 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs", | |
1915 Vi default: all flags) | |
1916 global | |
1917 {not in Vi} | |
1918 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present | |
5340 | 1919 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where |
1920 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred. | |
7 | 1921 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options". |
1922 Commas can be added for readability. | |
1923 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
1924 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
1925 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
1926 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
164 | 1927 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when |
1928 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1929 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1930 POSIX specification. |
7 | 1931 |
1932 contains behavior ~ | |
1933 *cpo-a* | |
1934 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
1935 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
1936 current window. | |
1937 *cpo-A* | |
1938 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
1939 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
1940 current window. | |
1941 *cpo-b* | |
1942 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of | |
1943 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping, | |
1944 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next | |
1945 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to | |
1946 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all | |
1947 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands. | |
1948 See also |map_bar|. | |
1949 *cpo-B* | |
1950 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings, | |
1951 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands. | |
1952 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a | |
1953 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>" | |
1954 results in X being mapped to: | |
1955 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>) | |
1956 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters) | |
1957 ('<' excluded in both cases) | |
1958 *cpo-c* | |
1959 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the | |
1960 cursor position, but not further than the start of the | |
1961 next line. When not present searching continues | |
1962 one character from the cursor position. With 'c' | |
1963 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating | |
1964 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches. | |
1965 *cpo-C* | |
1966 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a | |
1967 backslash. See |line-continuation|. | |
1968 *cpo-d* | |
1969 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use | |
1970 the tags file relative to the current file, but the | |
1971 tags file in the current directory. | |
1972 *cpo-D* | |
1973 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode | |
1974 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and | |
1975 |t|. | |
1976 *cpo-e* | |
1977 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a | |
1978 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not | |
1979 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register | |
1980 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a | |
1981 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line | |
1982 and can be edited before hitting <CR>. | |
1983 *cpo-E* | |
1984 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or | |
1985 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when | |
1986 at least one character is to be operate on. Example: | |
1987 This makes "y0" fail in the first column. | |
1988 *cpo-f* | |
1989 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
1990 argument will set the file name for the current buffer, | |
1991 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet. | |
1992 *cpo-F* | |
1993 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
1994 argument will set the file name for the current | |
1995 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name | |
590 | 1996 yet. Also see |cpo-P|. |
7 | 1997 *cpo-g* |
1998 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument. | |
164 | 1999 *cpo-H* |
2000 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert | |
2001 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after | |
2002 the last blank. | |
7 | 2003 *cpo-i* |
2004 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will | |
2005 leave it modified. | |
10 | 2006 *cpo-I* |
2007 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting | |
2008 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent. | |
7 | 2009 *cpo-j* |
2010 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.', | |
2011 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'. | |
2012 *cpo-J* | |
2013 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after | |
233 | 2014 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as |
7 | 2015 white space. |
2016 *cpo-k* | |
2017 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in | |
2018 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu | |
2019 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[ | |
2020 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X | |
2021 being mapped to: | |
2022 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters) | |
2023 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code) | |
2024 Also see the '<' flag below. | |
2025 *cpo-K* | |
2026 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is | |
2027 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when | |
2028 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It | |
2029 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>. | |
2030 *cpo-l* | |
2031 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
168 | 2032 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special. |
2033 See |/[]| | |
7 | 2034 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't' |
2035 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab> | |
168 | 2036 Also see |cpo-\|. |
7 | 2037 *cpo-L* |
2038 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin', | |
2039 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode | |
2040 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of | |
2041 the normal behavior of a <Tab>. | |
2042 *cpo-m* | |
2043 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a | |
2044 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half | |
2045 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'| | |
2046 *cpo-M* | |
2047 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into | |
2048 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer | |
2049 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores | |
2050 backslashes, which is Vi compatible. | |
2051 *cpo-n* | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2052 n When included, the column used for 'number' and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2053 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2054 lines. |
7 | 2055 *cpo-o* |
2056 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for | |
2057 next search. | |
2058 *cpo-O* | |
2059 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even | |
2060 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a | |
2061 protection against a file unexpectedly created by | |
2062 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this. | |
2063 *cpo-p* | |
2064 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a | |
2065 slightly better algorithm is used. | |
590 | 2066 *cpo-P* |
2067 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a | |
2068 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if | |
2069 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and | |
2070 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|. | |
164 | 2071 *cpo-q* |
2072 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the | |
2073 position where it would be when joining two lines. | |
7 | 2074 *cpo-r* |
2075 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search | |
2076 command, instead of the actually used search string. | |
2077 *cpo-R* | |
2078 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag | |
2079 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used. | |
2080 *cpo-s* | |
2081 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the | |
2082 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0. | |
10 | 2083 And it is the default. If not present the options are |
7 | 2084 set when the buffer is created. |
2085 *cpo-S* | |
2086 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer | |
2087 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and | |
2088 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting. | |
2089 The options are set to the values in the current | |
2090 buffer. When you change an option and go to another | |
2091 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the | |
2092 buffer options global to all buffers. | |
2093 | |
2094 's' 'S' copy buffer options | |
2095 no no when buffer created | |
2096 yes no when buffer first entered (default) | |
2097 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.) | |
2098 *cpo-t* | |
2099 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for | |
2100 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in | |
2101 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the | |
2102 last used search pattern. | |
2103 *cpo-u* | |
10 | 2104 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|. |
7 | 2105 *cpo-v* |
2106 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in | |
2107 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are | |
2108 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the | |
2109 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced | |
2110 characters. | |
2111 *cpo-w* | |
2112 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one | |
2113 character and not all blanks until the start of the | |
2114 next word. | |
2115 *cpo-W* | |
2116 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!" | |
2117 overwrites a readonly file, if possible. | |
2118 *cpo-x* | |
2119 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line. | |
2120 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line, | |
2121 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>| | |
164 | 2122 *cpo-X* |
2123 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is | |
2124 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "." | |
2125 and a count. | |
7 | 2126 *cpo-y* |
2127 y A yank command can be redone with ".". | |
164 | 2128 *cpo-Z* |
2129 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set, | |
2130 don't reset 'readonly'. | |
7 | 2131 *cpo-!* |
2132 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used | |
2133 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last | |
2134 used -filter- command is used. | |
2135 *cpo-$* | |
2136 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the | |
2137 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text. | |
2138 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the | |
2139 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any | |
2140 command that moves the cursor from the insertion | |
2141 point. | |
2142 *cpo-%* | |
2143 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command. | |
2144 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc. | |
2145 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/". | |
2146 Parens inside single and double quotes are also | |
2147 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to | |
2148 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like | |
2149 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not | |
2150 match the last one. When this flag is not included, | |
2151 parens inside single and double quotes are treated | |
2152 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes, | |
2153 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a | |
2154 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if | |
10 | 2155 there is one). This works very well for C programs. |
36 | 2156 This flag is also used for other features, such as |
2157 C-indenting. | |
161 | 2158 *cpo--* |
2159 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when | |
632 | 2160 it would go above the first line or below the last |
2161 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or | |
2162 last line, unless it already was in that line. | |
161 | 2163 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j", |
632 | 2164 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234". |
39 | 2165 *cpo-+* |
2166 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the | |
2167 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer | |
2168 itself may still be different from its file. | |
856 | 2169 *cpo-star* |
7 | 2170 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included, |
2171 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area. | |
2172 *cpo-<* | |
2173 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>| | |
2174 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of | |
10 | 2175 menu commands. For example, the command |
7 | 2176 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to: |
2177 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters) | |
2178 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>) | |
2179 Also see the 'k' flag above. | |
164 | 2180 *cpo->* |
2181 > When appending to a register, put a line break before | |
2182 the appended text. | |
2925 | 2183 *cpo-;* |
2184 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search | |
2185 and the cursor is right in front of the searched | |
2186 character, the cursor won't move. When not included, | |
2187 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the | |
3557 | 2188 following occurrence. |
164 | 2189 |
2190 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except | |
2191 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix| | |
2192 | |
2193 contains behavior ~ | |
856 | 2194 *cpo-#* |
164 | 2195 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect. |
168 | 2196 *cpo-&* |
2197 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when | |
2198 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded. | |
2199 This flag is tested when exiting. | |
2200 *cpo-\* | |
2201 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
2202 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]| | |
488 | 2203 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-' |
2204 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-' | |
2205 Also see |cpo-l|. | |
168 | 2206 *cpo-/* |
2207 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s| | |
2208 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%| | |
164 | 2209 *cpo-{* |
2210 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character | |
2211 at the start of a line. | |
168 | 2212 *cpo-.* |
2213 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current | |
2214 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't | |
2215 need this, since it remembers the full path of an | |
2216 opened file. | |
164 | 2217 *cpo-bar* |
2218 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment | |
2219 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained | |
2220 with system specific functions. | |
2221 | |
7 | 2222 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2223 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'* |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2224 'cryptmethod' string (default "zip") |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2225 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2226 {not in Vi} |
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2227 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file: |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2228 *pkzip* |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2229 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption. |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2230 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older. |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2231 *blowfish* |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2232 blowfish Blowfish method. Strong encryption. Requires Vim 7.3 |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2233 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2234 This adds a "seed" to the file, every time you write |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2235 the file the encrypted bytes will be different. |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2236 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2237 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2238 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2239 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used. |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2240 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2241 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2242 modifications. Also see |:X|. |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2243 |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2244 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2245 the value "zip". When setting the local value to an empty string the |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2246 buffer will use the global value. |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2247 |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2248 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2249 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* . |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2250 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2251 |
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2252 |
7 | 2253 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'* |
2254 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0) | |
2255 global | |
2256 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2257 feature} | |
2258 {not in Vi} | |
2259 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags. | |
2260 See |cscopepathcomp|. | |
2261 | |
2262 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'* | |
2263 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope") | |
2264 global | |
2265 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2266 feature} | |
2267 {not in Vi} | |
2268 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|. | |
2269 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2270 security reasons. | |
2271 | |
2272 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'* | |
2273 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "") | |
2274 global | |
2275 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2276 or |+quickfix| features} | |
2277 {not in Vi} | |
2278 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results. | |
2279 See |cscopequickfix|. | |
2280 | |
4869 | 2281 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'* |
2873 | 2282 'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off) |
2283 global | |
2284 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2285 feature} | |
2286 {not in Vi} | |
2287 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables | |
2288 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix. | |
2289 See |cscoperelative|. | |
2290 | |
7 | 2291 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'* |
2292 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off) | |
2293 global | |
2294 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2295 feature} | |
2296 {not in Vi} | |
2297 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|. | |
2298 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2299 | |
2300 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'* | |
2301 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0) | |
2302 global | |
2303 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2304 feature} | |
2305 {not in Vi} | |
2306 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See | |
2307 |cscopetagorder|. | |
2308 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
2309 | |
2310 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'* | |
2311 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'* | |
2312 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off) | |
2313 global | |
2314 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2315 feature} | |
2316 {not in Vi} | |
2317 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|. | |
2318 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2319 | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2320 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'* |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2321 'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off) |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2322 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2323 {not in Vi} |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2324 {not available when compiled without the |+cursorbind| |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2325 feature} |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2326 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2327 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2328 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2329 column. This option is useful for viewing the |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2330 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode, |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2331 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
2332 taken into account. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2333 |
743 | 2334 |
2335 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'* | |
2336 'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off) | |
2337 local to window | |
2338 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2339 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2340 feature} |
2341 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn | |
2342 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing | |
2343 slower. | |
826 | 2344 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use |
2345 these autocommands: > | |
2346 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn | |
2347 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn | |
2348 < | |
743 | 2349 |
2350 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'* | |
2351 'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off) | |
2352 local to window | |
2353 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2354 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2355 feature} |
2356 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine | |
2357 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen | |
2358 redrawing slower. | |
818 | 2359 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it |
825 | 2360 easier to see the selected text. |
743 | 2361 |
2362 | |
7 | 2363 *'debug'* |
2364 'debug' string (default "") | |
2365 global | |
2366 {not in Vi} | |
839 | 2367 These values can be used: |
2368 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2369 anyway. | |
2370 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2371 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|. | |
2372 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be | |
2373 produced. | |
168 | 2374 The values can be combined, separated by a comma. |
839 | 2375 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or |
2376 'indentexpr'. | |
7 | 2377 |
2378 *'define'* *'def'* | |
2379 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define") | |
2380 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2381 {not in Vi} | |
10 | 2382 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search |
7 | 2383 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the |
2384 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is | |
2385 used to recognize the defined name after the match: | |
2386 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char} | |
2387 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space | |
2388 or backslash. | |
2389 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be | |
2390 useful, to include const type declarations: > | |
2391 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\) | |
2392 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes! | |
2393 | |
2394 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'* | |
2395 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off) | |
2396 global | |
2397 {not in Vi} | |
2398 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
2399 feature} | |
2400 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode | |
2401 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the | |
2402 default) the character along with its combining characters are | |
2403 deleted. | |
2404 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"! | |
2405 | |
2406 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one | |
2407 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want | |
2408 to remove only the combining ones. | |
2409 | |
2410 *'dictionary'* *'dict'* | |
2411 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "") | |
2412 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2413 {not in Vi} | |
2414 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
2415 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should | |
2416 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several | |
2417 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is | |
2418 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes. | |
703 | 2419 When this option is empty, or an entry "spell" is present, spell |
2420 checking is enabled the currently active spelling is used. |spell| | |
10 | 2421 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 2422 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
2423 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
99 | 2424 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type. |
7 | 2425 Where to find a list of words? |
2426 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words". | |
2427 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory. | |
2428 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection. | |
2429 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2430 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2431 uses another default. | |
2432 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
2433 | |
2434 *'diff'* *'nodiff'* | |
2435 'diff' boolean (default off) | |
2436 local to window | |
2437 {not in Vi} | |
2438 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2439 feature} | |
2440 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences | |
10 | 2441 between files. See |vimdiff|. |
7 | 2442 |
2443 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'* | |
2444 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "") | |
2445 global | |
2446 {not in Vi} | |
2447 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2448 feature} | |
2449 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two | |
2450 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|. | |
2451 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2452 security reasons. | |
2453 | |
2454 *'dip'* *'diffopt'* | |
2455 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler") | |
2456 global | |
2457 {not in Vi} | |
2458 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2459 feature} | |
10 | 2460 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items. |
7 | 2461 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma. |
2462 | |
2463 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text | |
2464 synchronized with a window that has inserted | |
2465 lines at the same position. Mostly useful | |
2466 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind' | |
2467 is set. | |
2468 | |
2469 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change | |
2470 and a fold that contains unchanged lines. | |
2471 When omitted a context of six lines is used. | |
2472 See |fold-diff|. | |
2473 | |
2474 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A" | |
2475 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag | |
2476 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty. | |
2477 | |
2478 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds | |
2479 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2480 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2481 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2482 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing | |
2483 white space, but not leading white space. | |
2484 | |
766 | 2485 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless |
2486 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2487 | |
2488 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless | |
2489 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2490 | |
2491 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when | |
2492 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used. | |
2493 | |
7 | 2494 Examples: > |
2495 | |
2496 :set diffopt=filler,context:4 | |
2497 :set diffopt= | |
766 | 2498 :set diffopt=filler,foldcolumn:3 |
7 | 2499 < |
2500 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'* | |
2501 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off) | |
2502 global | |
2503 {not in Vi} | |
2504 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs| | |
2505 feature} | |
2506 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS> | |
2507 {char2}. See |digraphs|. | |
2508 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2509 | |
2510 *'directory'* *'dir'* | |
2511 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
5555 | 2512 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp" |
7 | 2513 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp") |
2514 global | |
2515 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas. | |
2516 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is | |
2517 possible. | |
2518 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is | |
2519 impossible!). | |
2520 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as | |
2521 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so | |
2522 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden" | |
2523 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible. | |
33 | 2524 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to |
7 | 2525 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading |
2526 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
459 | 2527 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//" |
2528 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to | |
2529 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs. | |
2530 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory. | |
1698 | 2531 On Win32, when a separating comma is following, you must use "//", |
2532 since "\\" will include the comma in the file name. | |
7 | 2533 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part |
2534 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
2535 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
2536 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
2537 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'. | |
2538 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2539 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
2540 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
2541 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
2542 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
2543 of the option is removed. | |
2544 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing | |
2545 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is | |
2546 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file. | |
2547 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better | |
2548 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap | |
2549 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your | |
2550 home directory is tried first. | |
2551 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2552 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2553 uses another default. | |
2554 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2555 security reasons. | |
2556 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"} | |
2557 | |
2558 *'display'* *'dy'* | |
2559 'display' 'dy' string (default "") | |
2560 global | |
2561 {not in Vi} | |
2562 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of | |
2563 flags: | |
2564 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line | |
10 | 2565 in a window will be displayed. When not included, a |
7 | 2566 last line that doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines. |
2567 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx> | |
2568 instead of using ^C and ~C. | |
2569 | |
2570 *'eadirection'* *'ead'* | |
2571 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both") | |
2572 global | |
2573 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2574 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 2575 feature} |
2576 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies: | |
2577 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected | |
2578 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected | |
2579 both width and height of windows is affected | |
2580 | |
2581 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'* | |
2582 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off) | |
2583 global | |
2584 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be | |
2585 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See | |
2586 also 'gdefault' option. | |
2587 Switching this option on is discouraged! | |
2588 | |
2589 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543* | |
2590 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG) | |
2591 global | |
2592 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
2593 feature} | |
2594 {not in Vi} | |
2595 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in | |
2596 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the | |
2597 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work | |
2598 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values. | |
2599 | |
2600 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the | |
39 | 2601 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid. |
7 | 2602 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim |
1152 | 2603 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|. |
7 | 2604 |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2605 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2606 corrupt the text. |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2607 |
7 | 2608 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to |
2609 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of | |
2610 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and | |
2611 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made | |
10 | 2612 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal |
7 | 2613 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files |
2614 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty). | |
2615 | |
2616 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'. | |
10 | 2617 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with |
7 | 2618 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'. |
2619 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2620 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2621 can use: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2622 if has("multi_byte_encoding") |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2623 < |
7 | 2624 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will |
2625 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If | |
2626 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be | |
2627 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|. | |
2628 | |
2629 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand | |
2630 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary. | |
2631 | |
2632 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
2633 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated | |
2634 to '-' signs. | |
2635 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name. | |
2636 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes | |
2637 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8". | |
2638 | |
2639 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected. | |
2640 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the | |
2641 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and | |
2642 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using | |
2643 utf-8. | |
2644 | |
2645 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8. | |
2646 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the | |
2647 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus | |
2648 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has | |
2649 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty. | |
448 | 2650 |
2651 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was | |
2652 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed. | |
7 | 2653 |
2654 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'* | |
2655 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on) | |
2656 local to buffer | |
2657 {not in Vi} | |
2658 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option | |
10 | 2659 is on, no <EOL> will be written for the last line in the file. This |
7 | 2660 option is automatically set when starting to edit a new file, unless |
2661 the file does not have an <EOL> for the last line in the file, in | |
2662 which case it is reset. Normally you don't have to set or reset this | |
2663 option. When 'binary' is off the value is not used when writing the | |
2664 file. When 'binary' is on it is used to remember the presence of a | |
2665 <EOL> for the last line in the file, so that when you write the file | |
2666 the situation from the original file can be kept. But you can change | |
2667 it if you want to. | |
2668 | |
2669 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'* | |
2670 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on) | |
2671 global | |
2672 {not in Vi} | |
2673 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after | |
33 | 2674 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the |
2675 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the | |
2676 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When | |
2677 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it | |
2678 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright'). | |
7 | 2679 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size |
2680 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The | |
2681 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected. | |
1354 | 2682 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting |
2683 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2684 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2685 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2686 the future). |
7 | 2687 |
2688 *'equalprg'* *'ep'* | |
2689 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "") | |
2690 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2691 {not in Vi} | |
2692 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty | |
1621 | 2693 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2694 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2695 the "indent" program is used. |
10 | 2696 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
7 | 2697 about including spaces and backslashes. |
2698 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2699 security reasons. | |
2700 | |
2701 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'* | |
2702 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off) | |
2703 global | |
2704 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only | |
2705 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always | |
2706 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal | |
10 | 2707 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep, |
7 | 2708 screen flash or do nothing. |
2709 | |
2710 *'errorfile'* *'ef'* | |
2711 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err", | |
2712 others: "errors.err") | |
2713 global | |
2714 {not in Vi} | |
2715 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2716 feature} | |
2717 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|). | |
2718 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the | |
2719 following argument. See |-q|. | |
2720 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that. | |
2721 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2722 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
2723 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2724 security reasons. | |
2725 | |
2726 *'errorformat'* *'efm'* | |
2727 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long) | |
2728 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2729 {not in Vi} | |
2730 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2731 feature} | |
2732 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file | |
2733 (see |errorformat|). | |
2734 | |
2735 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'* | |
2736 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
2737 global | |
2738 {not in Vi} | |
2739 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert | |
2740 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be | |
2741 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of | |
2742 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of | |
2743 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to | |
2744 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that | |
2745 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys | |
2746 won't work by default. | |
2747 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
2748 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
2749 | |
2750 *'eventignore'* *'ei'* | |
2751 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "") | |
2752 global | |
2753 {not in Vi} | |
2754 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd| | |
2755 feature} | |
2756 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored. | |
844 | 2757 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand |
2758 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed. | |
7 | 2759 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: > |
2760 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave | |
2761 < | |
2762 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'* | |
2763 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off) | |
2764 local to buffer | |
2765 {not in Vi} | |
2766 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a | |
10 | 2767 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and |
7 | 2768 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is |
2769 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|. | |
2770 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2771 | |
2772 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'* | |
2773 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off) | |
2774 global | |
2775 {not in Vi} | |
2776 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current | |
2777 directory. If you switch this option on you should also consider | |
2778 setting the 'secure' option (see |initialization|). Using a local | |
2779 .exrc, .vimrc or .gvimrc is a potential security leak, use with care! | |
2780 also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|. | |
2781 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2782 security reasons. | |
2783 | |
2784 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213* | |
2785 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "") | |
2786 local to buffer | |
2787 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
2788 feature} | |
2789 {not in Vi} | |
2790 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2791 |
7 | 2792 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2793 done when writing the file. For reading see below. |
7 | 2794 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be |
2795 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file). | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2796 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2797 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2798 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8. |
7 | 2799 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2800 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2801 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2802 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2803 characters may be lost! |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2804 |
7 | 2805 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be |
2806 specified that can be handled by the converter, see | |
2807 |mbyte-conversion|. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2808 |
7 | 2809 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'. |
2810 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting | |
1152 | 2811 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when |
2812 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used. | |
692 | 2813 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used. |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2814 |
7 | 2815 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored. |
2816 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
2817 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are | |
2818 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for | |
2819 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example | |
2820 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2". | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2821 |
7 | 2822 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' |
2823 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2824 |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2825 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2826 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2827 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2828 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q". |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2829 |
7 | 2830 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. |
2831 | |
2832 *'fe'* | |
2833 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the | |
10 | 2834 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The |
7 | 2835 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used. |
2836 | |
2837 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'* | |
39 | 2838 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom", |
2839 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when | |
2840 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value) | |
7 | 2841 global |
2842 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
2843 feature} | |
2844 {not in Vi} | |
2845 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit | |
2846 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first | |
2847 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one | |
2848 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works, | |
10 | 2849 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to |
7 | 2850 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used. |
2851 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When | |
2852 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants) | |
2853 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse | |
2854 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not | |
596 | 2855 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use |
2856 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters | |
2857 that can't be converted. | |
7 | 2858 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings |
2859 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except | |
2860 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer | |
2861 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your | |
2862 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: > | |
2863 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 | | |
2864 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif | |
2865 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain | |
2866 non-blank characters. | |
596 | 2867 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is |
2868 not used. | |
692 | 2869 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value |
2870 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: > | |
2871 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2 | |
2872 < This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than | |
2873 an empty file. | |
7 | 2874 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM |
2875 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded | |
2876 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly. | |
2877 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last, | |
2878 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always | |
2879 accepted. | |
39 | 2880 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the |
2881 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful | |
2882 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a | |
2883 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian. | |
777 | 2884 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte |
2885 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8| | |
2886 command to find the illegal byte sequence. | |
7 | 2887 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG: |
2888 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used | |
2889 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8 | |
2890 file | |
2891 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used | |
2892 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified. | |
2893 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values. | |
2894 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file | |
2895 is read. | |
2896 | |
2897 *'fileformat'* *'ff'* | |
2898 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos", | |
2899 Unix default: "unix", | |
2900 Macintosh default: "mac") | |
2901 local to buffer | |
2902 {not in Vi} | |
2903 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for | |
2904 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file: | |
2905 dos <CR> <NL> | |
2906 unix <NL> | |
2907 mac <CR> | |
2908 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored. | |
2909 See |file-formats| and |file-read|. | |
2910 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'. | |
2911 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O | |
4264 | 2912 works like it was set to "unix". |
7 | 2913 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and |
2914 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off. | |
2915 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' | |
2916 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
2917 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. | |
2918 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos", | |
2919 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset. | |
2920 | |
2921 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'* | |
2922 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default: | |
2923 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix", | |
2924 Vim Unix: "unix,dos", | |
2925 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos", | |
2926 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos", | |
2927 Vi others: "") | |
2928 global | |
2929 {not in Vi} | |
2930 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when | |
2931 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing | |
2932 buffer: | |
2933 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used | |
2934 always. It is not set automatically. | |
2935 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer | |
10 | 2936 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The |
7 | 2937 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing |
2938 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to. | |
2939 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic | |
2940 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to | |
2941 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>: | |
2942 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos", | |
2943 'fileformat' is set to "dos". | |
2944 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat' | |
10 | 2945 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a |
7 | 2946 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos". |
2587 | 2947 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if 'fileformats' |
2948 includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac". | |
2949 This means that "mac" is only chosen when: | |
2950 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and | |
2951 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file. | |
2952 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before | |
2953 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in | |
2642 | 2954 the first few lines, "mac" is used. |
7 | 2955 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from |
2956 'fileformats' is used. | |
2957 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but | |
2958 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that | |
2959 file only, the option is not changed. | |
2960 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used. | |
2961 | |
2662 | 2962 Note that when Vim starts up with an empty buffer this option is not |
2681 | 2963 used. Set 'fileformat' in your .vimrc instead. |
2662 | 2964 |
7 | 2965 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that |
2966 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be | |
2967 done: | |
2968 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos | |
2969 format will be used. | |
2970 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection | |
2971 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a | |
2972 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is | |
2973 used. | |
2974 Also see |file-formats|. | |
2975 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty | |
2976 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset, | |
2977 otherwise 'textauto' is set. | |
2978 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
2979 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
2980 | |
4264 | 2981 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'* |
2982 'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file | |
2983 names is normally ignored) | |
4242 | 2984 global |
2985 {not in Vi} | |
2986 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories. | |
2987 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion. | |
2988 | |
7 | 2989 *'filetype'* *'ft'* |
2990 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "") | |
2991 local to buffer | |
2992 {not in Vi} | |
2993 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd| | |
2994 feature} | |
2995 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered. | |
2996 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be | |
2997 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file | |
2998 name. | |
2999 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type. | |
3000 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable | |
3001 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype| | |
3002 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline, | |
3003 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized. | |
782 | 3004 Example, for in an IDL file: |
3005 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~ | |
3006 |FileType| |filetypes| | |
3007 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
3008 names. Example: | |
3009 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
3010 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype. | |
3011 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than | |
3012 one dot may appear. | |
7 | 3013 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or |
3014 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 3015 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 3016 |
3017 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'* | |
3018 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-") | |
3019 global | |
3020 {not in Vi} | |
3021 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| | |
3022 and |+folding| features} | |
3023 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators. | |
3024 It is a comma separated list of items: | |
3025 | |
3026 item default Used for ~ | |
3027 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window | |
3028 stlnc:c ' ' or '-' statusline of the non-current windows | |
3029 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit| | |
3030 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext' | |
3031 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option | |
3032 | |
10 | 3033 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and |
7 | 3034 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '-' |
3035 otherwise. | |
3036 | |
3037 Example: > | |
3038 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:-,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:- | |
3039 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also | |
3040 be used when there is highlighting. | |
3041 | |
819 | 3042 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported. |
3043 | |
7 | 3044 The highlighting used for these items: |
3045 item highlight group ~ | |
3046 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine| | |
3047 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC| | |
3048 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit| | |
3049 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded| | |
3050 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete| | |
3051 | |
3052 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'* | |
3053 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198* | |
3054 global | |
3055 {not in Vi} | |
3056 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3057 feature} | |
3058 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set. | |
3059 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to | |
10 | 3060 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 3061 |
3062 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'* | |
3063 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "") | |
3064 global | |
3065 {not in Vi} | |
3066 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3067 feature} | |
3068 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and | |
3069 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to | |
3070 automatically close when moving out of them. | |
3071 | |
3072 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'* | |
3073 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0) | |
3074 local to window | |
3075 {not in Vi} | |
3076 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3077 feature} | |
3078 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side | |
3079 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum | |
3080 value is 12. | |
3081 See |folding|. | |
3082 | |
3083 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'* | |
3084 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on) | |
3085 local to window | |
3086 {not in Vi} | |
3087 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3088 feature} | |
3089 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly | |
3090 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with | |
3091 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled | |
10 | 3092 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when |
7 | 3093 'foldenable' is off. |
3094 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold. | |
3095 See |folding|. | |
3096 | |
3097 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'* | |
3098 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0") | |
3099 local to window | |
3100 {not in Vi} | |
3101 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3102 or |+eval| features} |
7 | 3103 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated |
634 | 3104 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|. |
782 | 3105 |
3682 | 3106 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3107 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3108 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3109 on. |
634 | 3110 |
3111 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3112 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|. | |
7 | 3113 |
3114 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'* | |
3115 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#") | |
3116 local to window | |
3117 {not in Vi} | |
3118 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3119 feature} | |
3120 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with | |
3121 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding | |
10 | 3122 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character. |
7 | 3123 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|. |
3124 | |
3125 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'* | |
3126 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0) | |
3127 local to window | |
3128 {not in Vi} | |
3129 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3130 feature} | |
3131 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed. | |
3132 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will | |
3133 close fewer folds. | |
3134 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|. | |
3135 See |fold-foldlevel|. | |
3136 | |
3137 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'* | |
3138 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1) | |
3139 global | |
3140 {not in Vi} | |
3141 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3142 feature} | |
3143 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window. | |
3144 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero), | |
3145 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99). | |
3146 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline | |
10 | 3147 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also |
7 | 3148 ignores this option and closes all folds. |
3149 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to | |
3150 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files. | |
3151 When the value is negative, it is not used. | |
3152 | |
3153 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536* | |
3154 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}") | |
3155 local to window | |
3156 {not in Vi} | |
3157 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3158 feature} | |
3159 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There | |
3160 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The | |
3161 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow). | |
3162 See |fold-marker|. | |
3163 | |
3164 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'* | |
3165 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual") | |
3166 local to window | |
3167 {not in Vi} | |
3168 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3169 feature} | |
3170 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values: | |
3171 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually. | |
3172 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold. | |
3173 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line. | |
3174 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds. | |
3175 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds. | |
3176 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed. | |
3177 | |
3178 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'* | |
3179 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1) | |
3180 local to window | |
3181 {not in Vi} | |
3182 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3183 feature} | |
2709 | 3184 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed |
3185 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of | |
3186 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines. | |
3187 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line. | |
2826 | 3188 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using |
7 | 3189 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller |
3190 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold. | |
3191 | |
3192 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'* | |
3193 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20) | |
3194 local to window | |
3195 {not in Vi} | |
3196 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3197 feature} | |
3198 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax" | |
3199 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more | |
3200 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20. | |
3201 | |
3202 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'* | |
3203 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix, | |
3204 search,tag,undo") | |
3205 global | |
3206 {not in Vi} | |
3207 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3208 feature} | |
3209 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the | |
3210 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated | |
3211 list of items. | |
2625 | 3212 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. |
3213 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect. | |
3214 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself) | |
3215 | |
7 | 3216 item commands ~ |
3217 all any | |
3218 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc. | |
3219 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc. | |
3220 insert any command in Insert mode | |
3221 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc. | |
3222 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc. | |
3223 percent "%" | |
3224 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc. | |
3225 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc. | |
3226 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command) | |
819 | 3227 Also for |[s| and |]s|. |
7 | 3228 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc. |
3229 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R | |
3230 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%") | |
3231 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the | |
3232 whole closed fold. | |
3233 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it | |
3234 very difficult to move onto a closed fold. | |
3235 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open | |
3236 when text is inserted. | |
3237 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or | |
3238 set the 'foldclose' option to "all". | |
3239 | |
3240 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'* | |
3241 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()") | |
3242 local to window | |
3243 {not in Vi} | |
3244 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3245 feature} | |
3246 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed | |
3247 fold. See |fold-foldtext|. | |
3248 | |
3682 | 3249 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3250 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 3251 |
3252 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3253 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|. | |
3254 | |
7 | 3255 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'* |
3256 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt") | |
3257 local to buffer | |
3258 {not in Vi} | |
3259 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic | |
3260 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is | |
3261 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can | |
3262 be inserted for readability. | |
3263 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
3264 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
3265 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
3266 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
3267 | |
41 | 3268 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'* |
3269 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*") | |
3270 local to buffer | |
3271 {not in Vi} | |
3272 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for | |
3273 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'. | |
3274 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for | |
140 | 3275 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match |
41 | 3276 while still checking more characters. There must be a character |
3277 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled | |
3278 like there is no match. | |
3279 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation | |
3280 character and white space. | |
3281 | |
7 | 3282 *'formatprg'* *'fp'* |
3283 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "") | |
3284 global | |
3285 {not in Vi} | |
3286 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines | |
667 | 3287 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on |
7 | 3288 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is |
557 | 3289 such a program. |
667 | 3290 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead. |
3291 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal | |
3292 format function will be used |C-indenting|. | |
557 | 3293 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
3294 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3682 | 3295 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
3296 security reasons. | |
667 | 3297 |
3298 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'* | |
3299 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "") | |
3300 local to buffer | |
3301 {not in Vi} | |
3302 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| | |
3303 feature} | |
3304 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq| | |
2350
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2349
diff
changeset
|
3305 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2349
diff
changeset
|
3306 option is empty 'formatprg' is used. |
844 | 3307 |
3308 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted. | |
856 | 3309 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted. |
3310 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be | |
2350
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2349
diff
changeset
|
3311 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2349
diff
changeset
|
3312 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert |
06feaf4fe36a
Rename some "python3" symbols to "py3", as the command name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2349
diff
changeset
|
3313 it yet! |
844 | 3314 |
667 | 3315 Example: > |
681 | 3316 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format() |
667 | 3317 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the |
3318 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload| | |
3319 | |
3320 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding | |
3321 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as | |
3322 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the | |
3323 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will | |
2298
a3562a127cf6
When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2290
diff
changeset
|
3324 return "i" or "R" in this situation. |
a3562a127cf6
When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2290
diff
changeset
|
3325 |
a3562a127cf6
When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2290
diff
changeset
|
3326 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using |
a3562a127cf6
When 'formatexpr' evaluates to non-zero fall back to internal formatting, also
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2290
diff
changeset
|
3327 the internal format mechanism. |
667 | 3328 |
3682 | 3329 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
3330 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working, | |
3331 since changing the buffer text is not allowed. | |
667 | 3332 |
3333 *'fsync'* *'fs'* | |
36 | 3334 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on) |
3335 global | |
3336 {not in Vi} | |
3337 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a | |
3338 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely | |
3339 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This | |
3340 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop | |
3341 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that | |
3342 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On | |
3343 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always | |
3344 off. | |
3345 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files. | |
3346 | |
7 | 3347 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'* |
3348 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off) | |
3349 global | |
3350 {not in Vi} | |
3351 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that | |
3352 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag | |
3353 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution | |
3354 of all or one match. See |complex-change|. | |
3355 | |
3356 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~ | |
3357 :s/// subst. all subst. one | |
3358 :s///g subst. one subst. all | |
3359 :s///gg subst. all subst. one | |
3360 | |
3361 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
3362 | |
3363 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'* | |
3364 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l%m,%f %l%m") | |
3365 global | |
3366 {not in Vi} | |
3367 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output. | |
3368 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the | |
3369 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|. | |
3370 | |
3371 *'grepprg'* *'gp'* | |
3372 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ", | |
3373 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null", | |
3374 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n", | |
3375 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ") | |
3376 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
3377 {not in Vi} | |
233 | 3378 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%' |
7 | 3379 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command- |
3380 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments | |
3381 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See | |
3382 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3383 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep" | |
3384 also work well with a single file: > | |
3385 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH | |
161 | 3386 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command |
657 | 3387 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like |
3388 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|. | |
41 | 3389 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there |
7 | 3390 apply equally to 'grepprg'. |
3391 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found, | |
3392 otherwise it's "grep -n". | |
3393 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3394 security reasons. | |
3395 | |
3396 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549* | |
3397 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3398 ve:ver35-Cursor, | |
3399 o:hor50-Cursor, | |
3400 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3401 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3402 sm:block-Cursor | |
3403 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175", | |
3404 for MS-DOS and Win32 console: | |
3405 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15, | |
3406 r-cr:hor30,sm:block") | |
3407 global | |
3408 {not in Vi} | |
3409 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and | |
3410 for MS-DOS and Win32 console} | |
3411 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different | |
10 | 3412 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only |
7 | 3413 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by |
3414 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or | |
3415 horizontal cursor. | |
36 | 3416 For a console the 't_SI' and 't_EI' escape sequences are used. |
7 | 3417 |
10 | 3418 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a |
7 | 3419 mode-list and an argument-list: |
3420 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,.. | |
3421 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes: | |
3422 n Normal mode | |
3423 v Visual mode | |
3424 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
3425 if not specified) | |
3426 o Operator-pending mode | |
3427 i Insert mode | |
3428 r Replace mode | |
3429 c Command-line Normal (append) mode | |
3430 ci Command-line Insert mode | |
3431 cr Command-line Replace mode | |
3432 sm showmatch in Insert mode | |
3433 a all modes | |
3434 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments: | |
3435 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height | |
3436 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width | |
3437 block block cursor, fills the whole character | |
3438 [only one of the above three should be present] | |
3439 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking* | |
3440 blinkon{N} | |
3441 blinkoff{N} | |
3442 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before | |
3443 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that | |
3444 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the | |
3445 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one | |
3446 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The | |
3447 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250". | |
3448 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This | |
3449 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch | |
3450 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only | |
3451 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while | |
3452 executing a command. | |
3453 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see | |
3454 |xterm-blink|. | |
3455 {group-name} | |
3456 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font | |
3457 for the cursor | |
3458 {group-name}/{group-name} | |
3459 Two highlight group names, the first is used when | |
3460 no language mappings are used, the other when they | |
3461 are. |language-mapping| | |
3462 | |
3463 Examples of parts: | |
3464 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a | |
3465 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor" | |
3466 highlight group | |
3467 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150 | |
3468 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a | |
3469 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the | |
3470 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit | |
3471 faster. | |
3472 | |
3473 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for | |
3474 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used | |
3475 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off | |
3476 blinking: "a:blinkon0" | |
3477 | |
3478 Examples of cursor highlighting: > | |
3479 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE | |
3480 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg | |
3481 < | |
3482 *'guifont'* *'gfn'* | |
2908 | 3483 *E235* *E596* |
7 | 3484 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "") |
3485 global | |
3486 {not in Vi} | |
3487 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3488 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim. | |
3489 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When | |
3490 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other | |
3491 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas. | |
3492 The first valid font is used. | |
8 | 3493 |
170 | 3494 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is |
3495 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used. | |
8 | 3496 |
7 | 3497 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name |
3498 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra | |
3499 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also | |
3500 |option-backslash|. For example: > | |
3501 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas | |
8 | 3502 < will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it |
7 | 3503 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead. |
8 | 3504 |
3505 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting. | |
3506 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource | |
3507 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it | |
3508 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in | |
3509 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim | |
3510 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts. | |
3511 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3512 For Win32, GTK, Motif, Mac OS and Photon: > |
8 | 3513 :set guifont=* |
3514 < will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want. | |
3515 | |
3516 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a | |
3517 way to set 'guifont' for various systems. | |
3518 | |
7 | 3519 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: > |
3520 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3521 < That's all. XLFDs are not used. For Chinese this is reported to work |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3522 well: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3523 if has("gui_gtk2") |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3524 set guifont=Bitstream\ Vera\ Sans\ Mono\ 12,Fixed\ 12 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3525 set guifontwide=Microsoft\ Yahei\ 12,WenQuanYi\ Zen\ Hei\ 12 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3526 endif |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3527 < |
170 | 3528 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: > |
3529 :set guifont=Monaco:h10 | |
853 | 3530 < Also see 'macatsui', it can help fix display problems. |
3531 *E236* | |
7 | 3532 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same |
8 | 3533 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but |
3534 mono-spaced fonts look best. | |
3535 | |
7 | 3536 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel" |
3537 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts. | |
8 | 3538 |
7 | 3539 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245* |
3540 - takes these options in the font name: | |
3541 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point) | |
3542 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point) | |
3543 b - bold | |
3544 i - italic | |
3545 u - underline | |
3546 s - strikeout | |
233 | 3547 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC, |
7 | 3548 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK, |
3549 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS, | |
3550 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC. | |
22 | 3551 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT". |
7 | 3552 |
3553 Use a ':' to separate the options. | |
3554 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use | |
3555 backslashes to escape the spaces. | |
3556 - Examples: > | |
3557 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN | |
3558 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5 | |
3559 < See also |font-sizes|. | |
3560 | |
3561 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'* | |
3562 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598* | |
3563 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "") | |
3564 global | |
3565 {not in Vi} | |
3566 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and | |
3567 with the |+xfontset| feature} | |
3568 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI} | |
3569 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first | |
3570 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See | |
3571 |xfontset|. | |
3572 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as | |
3573 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the | |
3574 |:highlight| command. | |
3575 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the | |
3576 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting | |
3577 'guifontset' will fail. | |
3578 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont' | |
3579 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be | |
3580 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name, | |
3581 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative | |
3582 fontset names. | |
3583 This example works on many X11 systems: > | |
3584 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-* | |
3585 < | |
3586 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534* | |
3587 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "") | |
3588 global | |
3589 {not in Vi} | |
3590 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3591 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used | |
3592 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is | |
3593 used. | |
3594 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one | |
3595 specified with 'guifont' and the same height. | |
3596 | |
3597 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2: | |
3598 | |
3599 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and | |
3600 'guifontset' is empty or invalid. | |
3601 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and | |
3602 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching | |
3603 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it. | |
3604 | |
3605 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2* | |
3606 | |
3607 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width | |
3608 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8". | |
3609 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide' | |
10 | 3610 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the |
7 | 3611 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need |
3612 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice | |
3613 made by Pango/Xft. | |
3614 | |
4055 | 3615 Windows +multibyte only: *guifontwide_win_mbyte* |
3616 | |
4073 | 3617 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is used for IME instead of 'guifont'. |
4055 | 3618 |
7 | 3619 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'* |
3620 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50) | |
3621 global | |
3622 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI} | |
3623 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting | |
3624 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started, | |
3625 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will | |
10 | 3626 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel |
7 | 3627 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the |
3628 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the | |
3629 screen. | |
3630 | |
3631 *'guioptions'* *'go'* | |
3224 | 3632 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows), |
3633 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena)) | |
7 | 3634 global |
3635 {not in Vi} | |
3636 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
8 | 3637 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a |
7 | 3638 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the |
3639 GUI should be used. | |
3640 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
3641 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
3642 | |
3643 Valid letters are as follows: | |
1152 | 3644 *guioptions_a* *'go-a'* |
7 | 3645 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started, |
3646 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of | |
3647 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the | |
3648 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other | |
3649 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode | |
3650 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an | |
3651 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text | |
3652 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register. | |
3653 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other | |
3654 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended. | |
3655 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the | |
3656 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to | |
3657 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register. | |
3658 The same applies to the modeless selection. | |
3674 | 3659 *'go-P'* |
3660 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "* | |
3661 register. | |
1152 | 3662 *'go-A'* |
10 | 3663 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only |
7 | 3664 applies to the modeless selection. |
3665 | |
3666 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~ | |
3667 "" - - | |
3668 "a" yes yes | |
3669 "A" - yes | |
3670 "aA" yes yes | |
3671 | |
1152 | 3672 *'go-c'* |
7 | 3673 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple |
3674 choices. | |
1152 | 3675 *'go-e'* |
697 | 3676 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'. |
688 | 3677 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels. |
3678 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used. | |
857 | 3679 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently |
1621 | 3680 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows. |
1152 | 3681 *'go-f'* |
7 | 3682 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell |
3683 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the | |
3684 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you | |
3685 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the | |
3686 foreground. |gui-fork| | |
3687 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have | |
819 | 3688 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read. |
1152 | 3689 *'go-i'* |
7 | 3690 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper |
3691 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of | |
3692 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3693 *'go-m'* |
7 | 3694 'm' Menu bar is present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3695 *'go-M'* |
10 | 3696 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note |
7 | 3697 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before |
819 | 3698 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc| |
7 | 3699 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the |
3700 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too). | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3701 *'go-g'* |
7 | 3702 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If |
3703 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all. | |
3704 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items. | |
1152 | 3705 *'go-t'* |
7 | 3706 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32, |
3707 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI. | |
1152 | 3708 *'go-T'* |
236 | 3709 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon |
856 | 3710 and Athena GUIs. |
1152 | 3711 *'go-r'* |
7 | 3712 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3713 *'go-R'* |
7 | 3714 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3715 split window. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3716 *'go-l'* |
7 | 3717 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3718 *'go-L'* |
7 | 3719 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3720 split window. | |
1152 | 3721 *'go-b'* |
7 | 3722 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on |
3723 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h' | |
3724 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3725 *'go-h'* |
7 | 3726 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor |
3727 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
3728 | |
3729 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if | |
3730 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information. | |
3731 | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3732 *'go-v'* |
7 | 3733 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included, |
3734 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a | |
3735 vertical layout is used anyway. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3736 *'go-p'* |
7 | 3737 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some |
3738 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at | |
3739 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done | |
819 | 3740 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or |
7 | 3741 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3742 *'go-F'* |
10 | 3743 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|. |
7 | 3744 |
1152 | 3745 |
7 | 3746 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'* |
3747 'guipty' boolean (default on) | |
3748 global | |
3749 {not in Vi} | |
3750 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3751 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for | |
3752 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|. | |
3753 | |
688 | 3754 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'* |
3755 'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty) | |
3756 global | |
3757 {not in Vi} | |
692 | 3758 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3759 with the |+windows| feature} |
688 | 3760 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab |
857 | 3761 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a |
3762 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info. | |
688 | 3763 |
692 | 3764 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
839 | 3765 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below. |
692 | 3766 |
688 | 3767 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be |
3768 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is | |
3769 used. | |
3770 | |
839 | 3771 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'* |
3772 'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty) | |
3773 global | |
3774 {not in Vi} | |
3775 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3776 with the |+windows| feature} |
839 | 3777 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab |
3778 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip. | |
3779 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3780 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3781 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3782 < |
839 | 3783 |
7 | 3784 *'helpfile'* *'hf'* |
3785 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt" | |
3786 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt") | |
3787 global | |
3788 {not in Vi} | |
3789 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be | |
3790 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories | |
3791 in 'runtimepath' will be used. | |
3792 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example: | |
3793 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also | |
10 | 3794 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including |
7 | 3795 spaces and backslashes. |
3796 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3797 security reasons. | |
3798 | |
3799 *'helpheight'* *'hh'* | |
3800 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20) | |
3801 global | |
3802 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3803 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 3804 feature} |
3805 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the | |
3806 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the | |
3807 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other | |
3808 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is | |
3809 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable. | |
3810 | |
3811 *'helplang'* *'hlg'* | |
3812 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty) | |
3813 global | |
3814 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang| | |
3815 feature} | |
3816 {not in Vi} | |
3817 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language | |
3818 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always | |
3819 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over | |
3820 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that | |
3821 language and not in the English help. | |
3822 Example: > | |
3823 :set helplang=de,it | |
3824 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help | |
3825 files. | |
3826 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will | |
3827 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option. | |
3828 See |help-translated|. | |
3829 | |
3830 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'* | |
3831 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off) | |
3832 global | |
3833 {not in Vi} | |
3834 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a | |
3835 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still | |
3836 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course. | |
3837 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer | |
3838 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is | |
3839 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!' | |
10 | 3840 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|. |
12 | 3841 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option. |
7 | 3842 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|. |
3843 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers. | |
3844 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!". | |
3845 | |
3846 *'highlight'* *'hl'* | |
3847 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string): | |
3848 "8:SpecialKey,@:NonText,d:Directory, | |
3849 e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,l:Search,m:MoreMsg, | |
3445 | 3850 M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,N:CursorLineNr, |
3851 r:Question,s:StatusLine,S:StatusLineNC, | |
3852 c:VertSplit, t:Title,v:Visual, | |
3853 w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu, | |
7 | 3854 f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd, |
3855 C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText, | |
386 | 3856 >:SignColumn,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap, |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
3857 R:SpellRare,L:SpellLocal,-:Conceal, |
540 | 3858 +:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel, |
3859 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb") | |
7 | 3860 global |
3861 {not in Vi} | |
3862 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various | |
3863 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The | |
3864 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to | |
10 | 3865 use for that occasion. The occasions are: |
7 | 3866 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map" |
3867 |hl-NonText| @ '~' and '@' at the end of the window and | |
3868 characters from 'showbreak' | |
3869 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special | |
3870 things in listings | |
3871 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages | |
3872 h (obsolete, ignored) | |
3873 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting | |
3874 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch') | |
3875 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt| | |
3876 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --") | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3877 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3878 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set. |
4073 | 3879 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is |
3880 set. | |
7 | 3881 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions |
3882 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line| | |
3883 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows | |
3884 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc. | |
3885 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows | |
3886 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode | |
3887 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the | |
3888 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and | |
3889 |xterm-clipboard|. | |
3890 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages | |
3891 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu' | |
3892 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds | |
3893 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn' | |
386 | 3894 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode |
3895 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode | |
3896 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode | |
3897 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode | |
7 | 3898 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs| |
221 | 3899 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell| |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3900 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell| |
221 | 3901 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell| |
3902 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell| | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
3903 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
3904 (see 'conceallevel') |
540 | 3905 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line |
3906 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line | |
3907 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar | |
3908 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb | |
7 | 3909 |
3910 The display modes are: | |
3911 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me") | |
3912 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR") | |
3913 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me") | |
3914 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se") | |
3915 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue") | |
205 | 3916 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce") |
7 | 3917 n no highlighting |
3918 - no highlighting | |
3919 : use a highlight group | |
3920 The default is used for occasions that are not included. | |
3921 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors| | |
3922 for an example. | |
3923 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of | |
3924 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type | |
3925 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to | |
3926 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion. | |
3927 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups. | |
3928 | |
3929 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'* | |
3930 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off) | |
3931 global | |
3932 {not in Vi} | |
3933 {not available when compiled without the | |
3934 |+extra_search| feature} | |
3935 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches. | |
3936 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the | |
3937 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by | |
3938 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets | |
3939 are not applied. | |
3940 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|. | |
3941 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it | |
3224 | 3942 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as |
3943 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back. | |
1621 | 3944 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches. |
7 | 3945 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to |
3946 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the | |
10 | 3947 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first |
7 | 3948 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not |
819 | 3949 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line. |
3224 | 3950 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup |
3951 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|. | |
7 | 3952 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
3953 | |
3954 *'history'* *'hi'* | |
5991 | 3955 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0) |
7 | 3956 global |
3957 {not in Vi} | |
3958 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns | |
5991 | 3959 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in |
7 | 3960 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|). |
5991 | 3961 The maximum value is 10000. |
7 | 3962 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
3963 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
3964 | |
3965 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'* | |
3966 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off) | |
3967 global | |
3968 {not in Vi} | |
3969 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3970 feature} | |
3971 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set. | |
3972 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to | |
3973 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|. | |
3974 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
3975 | |
3976 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'* | |
3977 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off) | |
3978 global | |
3979 {not in Vi} | |
3980 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3981 feature} | |
3982 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on. | |
3983 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard. | |
3984 See |rileft.txt|. | |
3985 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
3986 | |
3987 *'icon'* *'noicon'* | |
3988 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
3989 global | |
3990 {not in Vi} | |
3991 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
3992 feature} | |
3993 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of | |
3994 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file | |
3995 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used. | |
3996 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option. | |
3997 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently | |
3998 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are | |
3999 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the | |
4000 builtin termcap). | |
4001 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
233 | 4002 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on |
7 | 4003 X11. |
4004 | |
4005 *'iconstring'* | |
4006 'iconstring' string (default "") | |
4007 global | |
4008 {not in Vi} | |
4009 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
4010 feature} | |
4011 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of | |
4012 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on. | |
4013 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text | |
4014 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option). | |
4015 Does not work for MS Windows. | |
4016 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
4017 restored if possible |X11|. | |
4018 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be | |
10 | 4019 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See |
7 | 4020 'titlestring' for example settings. |
4021 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} | |
4022 | |
4023 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'* | |
4024 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off) | |
4025 global | |
4026 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags | |
4027 file. | |
4028 Also see 'smartcase'. | |
4029 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see | |
4030 |/ignorecase|. | |
4031 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4032 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4033 'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4034 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4035 {not in Vi} |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4036 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4037 |+GUI_GTK|} |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4038 This option specifies a function that will be called to |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4039 activate/inactivate Input Method. |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4040 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4041 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4042 function ImActivateFunc(active) |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4043 if a:active |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4044 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4045 else |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4046 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4047 endif |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4048 " return value is not used |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4049 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4050 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4051 < |
7 | 4052 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'* |
4053 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "") | |
4054 global | |
4055 {not in Vi} | |
4056 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and | |
2209
d0ddf7ba1630
Included the patch to support netbeans in a terminal.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2207
diff
changeset
|
4057 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599* |
7 | 4058 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for |
4059 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control | |
4060 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'. | |
4061 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option | |
4062 tells Vim what the key is. | |
4063 Format: | |
4064 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING | |
4065 | |
4066 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored): | |
4067 S Shift key | |
4068 L Lock key | |
4069 C Control key | |
4070 1 Mod1 key | |
4071 2 Mod2 key | |
4072 3 Mod3 key | |
4073 4 Mod4 key | |
4074 5 Mod5 key | |
4075 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are | |
4076 both shift+ctrl+space. | |
4077 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING. | |
4078 | |
4079 Example: > | |
4080 :set imactivatekey=S-space | |
4081 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 + | |
4082 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean). | |
4083 | |
4084 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'* | |
4085 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off) | |
4086 global | |
4087 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4088 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|, |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4089 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features} |
7 | 4090 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command |
4091 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that). | |
4092 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering | |
4093 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented | |
4094 characters with dead keys. | |
4095 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4096 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'* |
7 | 4097 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI)) |
4098 global | |
4099 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4100 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|, |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4101 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features} |
7 | 4102 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable |
4103 the IM when it doesn't work properly. | |
4104 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This | |
4105 may change in later releases. | |
4106 | |
4107 *'iminsert'* *'imi'* | |
4108 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported) | |
4109 local to buffer | |
4110 {not in Vi} | |
4111 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in | |
4112 Insert mode. Valid values: | |
4113 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4114 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4115 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4116 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim| | |
4117 or |global-ime|. | |
4118 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc> | |
4119 this can be used: > | |
4120 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR> | |
4121 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert | |
4122 mode. | |
4123 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode | |
4124 |i_CTRL-^|. | |
4125 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name. | |
4126 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f". | |
4127 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4128 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4129 | |
4130 *'imsearch'* *'ims'* | |
4131 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported) | |
4132 local to buffer | |
4133 {not in Vi} | |
4134 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when | |
4135 entering a search pattern. Valid values: | |
4136 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like | |
4137 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern | |
4138 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4139 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4140 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4141 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode | |
4142 |c_CTRL-^|. | |
4143 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap' | |
4144 option to a valid keymap name. | |
4145 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4146 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4147 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4148 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4149 'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4150 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4151 {not in Vi} |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4152 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4153 |+GUI_GTK|} |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4154 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4155 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active. |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4156 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4157 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4158 function ImStatusFunc() |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4159 let is_active = ...do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4160 return is_active ? 1 : 0 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4161 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4162 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4163 < |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4164 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast. |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4165 |
7 | 4166 *'include'* *'inc'* |
4167 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include") | |
4168 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
4169 {not in Vi} | |
4170 {not available when compiled without the | |
4171 |+find_in_path| feature} | |
10 | 4172 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search |
7 | 4173 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default |
4174 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i", | |
532 | 4175 "]I", "[d", etc. |
4176 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that | |
534 | 4177 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern |
4178 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it | |
4179 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters | |
4180 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use | |
4181 'includeexpr' to process the matched text. | |
532 | 4182 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
7 | 4183 |
4184 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'* | |
4185 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "") | |
4186 local to buffer | |
4187 {not in Vi} | |
4188 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4189 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features} |
7 | 4190 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include' |
10 | 4191 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: > |
7 | 4192 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g') |
4193 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected. | |
634 | 4194 |
7 | 4195 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be |
10 | 4196 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement. |
7 | 4197 Also used for |<cfile>|. |
4198 | |
3682 | 4199 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4200 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 4201 |
4202 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4203 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|. | |
4204 | |
7 | 4205 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'* |
4206 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off) | |
4207 global | |
4208 {not in Vi} | |
4209 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4210 |+extra_search| features} |
17 | 4211 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed |
4212 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern | |
4213 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated | |
4214 often, this is only useful on fast terminals. | |
4215 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its | |
4216 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You | |
4217 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the | |
4218 cursor to the match. | |
1521 | 4219 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about |
4220 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the | |
4221 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you | |
4222 are typing the pattern. | |
17 | 4223 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'. |
4224 See also: 'hlsearch'. | |
772 | 4225 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match |
2302
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4226 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4227 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4228 converted to lowercase. |
772 | 4229 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current |
4230 match, excluding the characters that were already typed. | |
7 | 4231 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
4232 | |
4233 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'* | |
4234 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "") | |
4235 local to buffer | |
4236 {not in Vi} | |
4237 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4238 or |+eval| features} | |
4239 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line. | |
4240 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and | |
4241 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option. | |
4242 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and | |
2833 | 4243 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is |
4244 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm. | |
7 | 4245 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting. |
4246 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for | |
534 | 4247 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line |
7 | 4248 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around). |
4249 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It | |
4250 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is | |
4251 used for the indent). | |
4252 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()| | |
4253 and |lispindent()|. | |
4254 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must | |
4255 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the | |
4256 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved. | |
4257 Normally this option would be set to call a function: > | |
4258 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent() | |
4259 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains | |
4260 "msg". | |
634 | 4261 See |indent-expression|. |
7 | 4262 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set. |
4263 | |
3682 | 4264 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4265 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 4266 |
4267 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4268 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|. | |
4269 | |
4270 | |
7 | 4271 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'* |
4272 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") | |
4273 local to buffer | |
4274 {not in Vi} | |
4275 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4276 feature} | |
4277 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
4278 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty. | |
4279 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|. | |
4280 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|. | |
4281 | |
4282 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'* | |
4283 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off) | |
4284 local to buffer | |
4285 {not in Vi} | |
4286 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and | |
1621 | 4287 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending |
4288 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter | |
4289 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made | |
4290 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match | |
4291 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter, | |
4292 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase. | |
4293 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is. | |
7 | 4294 |
4295 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'* | |
4296 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off) | |
4297 global | |
4298 {not in Vi} | |
4299 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful | |
4300 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|. | |
4301 These Insert mode commands will be useful: | |
4302 - Use the cursor keys to move around. | |
4303 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|). When | |
4304 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off. | |
4305 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished. | |
4306 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use | |
477 | 4307 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor |
4308 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L| | |
7 | 4309 |
4310 These items change when 'insertmode' is set: | |
4311 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode. | |
4312 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps. | |
4313 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode. | |
4314 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted. | |
4315 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z* | |
4316 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like | |
4317 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same | |
4318 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set. | |
4319 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used. | |
4320 | |
4321 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4322 | |
4323 *'isfname'* *'isf'* | |
4324 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: | |
4325 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,=" | |
4326 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:" | |
4327 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~" | |
4328 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=" | |
4329 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=") | |
4330 global | |
4331 {not in Vi} | |
4332 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and | |
4333 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in | |
10 | 4334 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|. |
7 | 4335 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the |
4336 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. | |
4337 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well. | |
1621 | 4338 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a |
4339 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim | |
4340 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion. | |
4341 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'. | |
7 | 4342 |
4343 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to | |
4344 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit | |
4345 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special | |
4346 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file | |
4347 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The | |
4348 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for | |
4349 cmd.exe. | |
4350 | |
4351 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas. | |
10 | 4352 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two |
4353 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a | |
7 | 4354 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does |
4355 not work for digits). Example: | |
4356 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range | |
4357 128 to 140 and '#' to 43) | |
4358 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range | |
4359 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left | |
4360 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is | |
4361 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the | |
4362 option or the end of a range. Example: | |
4363 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^') | |
4364 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE | |
4365 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z, | |
4366 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples: | |
4367 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower | |
1621 | 4368 case ASCII letters. |
7 | 4369 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character. |
4370 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is | |
4371 expected. Example: | |
4372 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore. | |
4373 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example: | |
4374 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding | |
4375 comma, plus <Tab>. | |
4376 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4377 | |
4378 *'isident'* *'isi'* | |
4379 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: | |
4380 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" | |
4381 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255") | |
4382 global | |
4383 {not in Vi} | |
4384 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers. | |
4385 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a | |
4386 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a | |
233 | 4387 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this |
7 | 4388 option. |
4389 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding | |
10 | 4390 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to |
7 | 4391 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead. |
4392 | |
4393 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'* | |
4394 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32: | |
4395 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" | |
4396 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255" | |
4397 Vi default: "@,48-57,_") | |
4398 local to buffer | |
4399 {not in Vi} | |
4400 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands: | |
10 | 4401 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See |
7 | 4402 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C |
4403 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>". | |
4404 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except | |
4405 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that | |
4406 command). | |
4407 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included. | |
4408 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
4409 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
4410 | |
4411 *'isprint'* *'isp'* | |
4412 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh: | |
4413 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255") | |
4414 global | |
4415 {not in Vi} | |
4416 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the | |
4417 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from | |
4418 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly, | |
4419 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See | |
4420 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. | |
4421 | |
4422 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters: | |
4423 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_" | |
4424 32 - 126 always single characters | |
4425 127 "^?" | |
4426 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_" | |
4427 160 - 254 "| " - "|~" | |
4428 255 "~?" | |
4429 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are | |
4430 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte. | |
4431 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are | |
4432 displayed as <xx>. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4433 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4434 |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4435 |
4436 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the | |
4437 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character | |
4438 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a | |
4439 replacement character will be shown. | |
4440 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>. | |
4441 There is no option to specify these characters. | |
4442 | |
4443 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'* | |
4444 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on) | |
4445 global | |
4446 {not in Vi} | |
4447 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command. | |
4448 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'. | |
4449 Otherwise only one space is inserted. | |
4450 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
4451 | |
4452 *'key'* | |
4453 'key' string (default "") | |
4454 local to buffer | |
4455 {not in Vi} | |
2283
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4456 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv| |
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4457 feature} |
7 | 4458 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
4459 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'. |
7 | 4460 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed |
4461 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: > | |
4462 :set key= | |
4463 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or | |
4464 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't | |
4465 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it, | |
4466 be careful not to make a typing error! | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4467 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4468 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars). |
7 | 4469 |
4470 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544* | |
4471 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "") | |
4472 local to buffer | |
4473 {not in Vi} | |
4474 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap| | |
4475 feature} | |
4476 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|. | |
4477 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of | |
4478 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective. | |
4479 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1 | |
36 | 4480 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4481 |
4482 *'keymodel'* *'km'* | |
4483 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "") | |
4484 global | |
4485 {not in Vi} | |
4486 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys | |
4487 can do. These values can be used: | |
4488 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either | |
4489 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being | |
4490 present in 'selectmode'). | |
4491 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection. | |
4492 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>, | |
4493 <PageUp> and <PageDown>. | |
4494 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
4495 | |
4496 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'* | |
4497 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help", | |
4498 OS/2: "view /", VMS: "help") | |
4499 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
4500 {not in Vi} | |
4501 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are | |
4502 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal | |
4503 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty | |
4504 value did this, which is now deprecated.) | |
4505 When "man" is used, Vim will automatically translate a count for the | |
4506 "K" command to a section number. Also for "man -s", in which case the | |
4507 "-s" is removed when there is no count. | |
4508 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4509 Example: > | |
4510 :set keywordprg=man\ -s | |
4511 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4512 security reasons. | |
4513 | |
4514 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358* | |
4515 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "") | |
4516 global | |
4517 {not in Vi} | |
4518 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| | |
4519 feature} | |
4520 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language | |
10 | 4521 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are |
7 | 4522 inserted directly. When in command mode the 'langmap' option takes |
4523 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning | |
4524 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to | |
4525 be able to execute Normal mode commands. | |
4526 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are | |
4527 mapped in Insert mode. | |
5908 | 4528 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
4529 security reasons. | |
7 | 4530 |
699 | 4531 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* > |
4532 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz | |
7 | 4533 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): > |
4534 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ | |
4535 < | |
4536 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each | |
4537 part can be in one of two forms: | |
4538 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately | |
4539 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC". | |
4540 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to" | |
4541 characters. Example: "abc;ABC" | |
4542 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE" | |
4543 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are | |
4544 ";", ',' and backslash itself. | |
4545 | |
4546 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch | |
4547 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will | |
4548 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the | |
4549 langmap mappings) in the following cases: | |
4550 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings) | |
4551 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R | |
4552 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings | |
4553 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by | |
4554 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time | |
4555 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings. | |
4556 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time! | |
4557 | |
4558 *'langmenu'* *'lm'* | |
4559 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "") | |
4560 global | |
4561 {not in Vi} | |
4562 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and | |
4563 |+multi_lang| features} | |
4564 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded | |
4565 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': > | |
4566 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim" | |
4567 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no | |
4568 matter what $LANG is set to: > | |
4569 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1 | |
4570 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used. | |
36 | 4571 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4572 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use |
4573 the English menus: > | |
4574 :set langmenu=none | |
4575 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype | |
4576 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting | |
4577 this option has no effect. But you could do this: > | |
4578 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim | |
4579 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1 | |
4580 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim | |
4581 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself! | |
4582 | |
4583 *'laststatus'* *'ls'* | |
4584 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1) | |
4585 global | |
4586 {not in Vi} | |
4587 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a | |
4588 status line: | |
4589 0: never | |
4590 1: only if there are at least two windows | |
4591 2: always | |
4592 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several | |
4593 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line| | |
4594 | |
4595 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'* | |
4596 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off) | |
4597 global | |
4598 {not in Vi} | |
4599 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while | |
4600 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been | |
10 | 4601 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an |
7 | 4602 update use |:redraw|. |
4603 | |
4604 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'* | |
4605 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off) | |
4606 local to window | |
4607 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4608 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 4609 feature} |
6009 | 4610 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather |
7 | 4611 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike |
4612 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file, | |
6009 | 4613 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. |
4614 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value | |
4615 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option | |
6026 | 4616 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off. |
7 | 4617 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed |
4618 with the right amount of white space. | |
4619 | |
4620 *'lines'* *E593* | |
4621 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height) | |
4622 global | |
4623 Number of lines of the Vim window. | |
4624 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the | |
161 | 4625 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|. |
7 | 4626 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
4627 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
4628 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
4629 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can | |
4630 use this command to get the tallest window possible: > | |
4631 :set lines=999 | |
571 | 4632 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000. |
4633 If you get less lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option. | |
7 | 4634 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical |
4635 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up. | |
4636 | |
4637 *'linespace'* *'lsp'* | |
4638 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI) | |
4639 global | |
4640 {not in Vi} | |
4641 {only in the GUI} | |
4642 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font | |
4643 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other. | |
4644 When non-zero there is room for underlining. | |
180 | 4645 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have |
4646 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set | |
4647 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems | |
4648 though! | |
7 | 4649 |
4650 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'* | |
4651 'lisp' boolean (default off) | |
4652 local to buffer | |
4653 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| | |
4654 feature} | |
4655 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for | |
4656 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with | |
4657 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p' | |
4658 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or | |
4659 better. Also see 'lispwords'. | |
4660 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the | |
4661 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than | |
4662 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty. | |
4663 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
4664 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently} | |
4665 | |
4666 *'lispwords'* *'lw'* | |
4667 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long) | |
5712 | 4668 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 4669 {not in Vi} |
4670 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| | |
4671 feature} | |
4672 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting. | |
4673 |'lisp'| | |
4674 | |
4675 *'list'* *'nolist'* | |
4676 'list' boolean (default off) | |
4677 local to window | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4678 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4679 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4680 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4681 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4682 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4683 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4684 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: > |
5161
f7add3891e95
Updated runtime files. Fix NL translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5146
diff
changeset
|
4685 :set list lcs=tab:\ \ |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4686 < |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4687 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4688 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for |
7 | 4689 changing the way tabs are displayed. |
4690 | |
4691 *'listchars'* *'lcs'* | |
4692 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$") | |
4693 global | |
4694 {not in Vi} | |
2458 | 4695 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a |
4696 comma separated list of string settings. | |
3682 | 4697 *lcs-eol* |
7 | 4698 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When |
4699 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the | |
4700 line. | |
3682 | 4701 *lcs-tab* |
1263 | 4702 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a tab. The first |
7 | 4703 char is used once. The second char is repeated to |
1263 | 4704 fill the space that the tab normally occupies. |
4705 "tab:>-" will show a tab that takes four spaces as | |
4706 ">---". When omitted, a tab is show as ^I. | |
3682 | 4707 *lcs-trail* |
10 | 4708 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted, |
7 | 4709 trailing spaces are blank. |
3682 | 4710 *lcs-extends* |
7 | 4711 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is |
4712 off and the line continues beyond the right of the | |
4713 screen. | |
3682 | 4714 *lcs-precedes* |
7 | 4715 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap' |
4716 is off and there is text preceding the character | |
4717 visible in the first column. | |
3682 | 4718 *lcs-conceal* |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
4719 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
4720 'conceallevel' is set to 1. |
3682 | 4721 *lcs-nbsp* |
13 | 4722 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character |
856 | 4723 0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted. |
7 | 4724 |
10 | 4725 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can |
7 | 4726 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable |
819 | 4727 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width. |
7 | 4728 |
4729 Examples: > | |
4730 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:- | |
12 | 4731 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:% |
7 | 4732 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:< |
4733 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and | |
12 | 4734 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "tab" and "trail". |
1152 | 4735 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4736 |
4737 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'* | |
4738 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on) | |
4739 global | |
4740 {not in Vi} | |
4741 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|. | |
4742 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading | |
4743 of plugins. | |
4744 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments | |
4745 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin| | |
4746 | |
842 | 4747 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'* |
4748 'macatsui' boolean (default on) | |
4749 global | |
4750 {only available in Mac GUI version} | |
4751 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set | |
4752 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When | |
4753 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when | |
4754 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may | |
4755 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method | |
4756 to unset it: > | |
4757 if exists('&macatsui') | |
4758 set nomacatsui | |
4759 endif | |
1152 | 4760 < Another option to check if you have drawing problems is |
4761 'termencoding'. | |
4762 | |
7 | 4763 *'magic'* *'nomagic'* |
4764 'magic' boolean (default on) | |
4765 global | |
4766 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns. | |
4767 See |pattern|. | |
4768 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with using patterns, always keep | |
4769 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with | |
4770 old Vi scripts. In any other situation write patterns that work when | |
20 | 4771 'magic' is on. Include "\M" when you want to |/\M|. |
7 | 4772 |
4773 *'makeef'* *'mef'* | |
4774 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "") | |
4775 global | |
4776 {not in Vi} | |
4777 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
4778 feature} | |
4779 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|) | |
4780 and the |:grep| command. | |
4781 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used. | |
4782 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name | |
4783 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an | |
4784 existing file. | |
4785 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that. | |
4786 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
4787 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4788 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4789 security reasons. | |
4790 | |
4791 *'makeprg'* *'mp'* | |
4792 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS") | |
4793 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
4794 {not in Vi} | |
1152 | 4795 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|. |
5690 | 4796 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|), |
4797 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S| | |
4798 to escape file names in case they contain special characters. | |
1152 | 4799 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
4800 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4801 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for | |
4802 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called | |
4803 "myfilter" do it like this: > | |
7 | 4804 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter |
4805 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify | |
4806 where the arguments will be included, for example: > | |
4807 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*} | |
4808 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4809 security reasons. | |
4810 | |
4811 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'* | |
4812 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]") | |
4813 local to buffer | |
4814 {not in Vi} | |
4815 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the | |
4073 | 4816 other. |
4817 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot | |
4818 jump between two double quotes. | |
4819 The characters must be separated by a colon. | |
1152 | 4820 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and |
4821 '>' (HTML): > | |
7 | 4822 :set mps+=<:> |
4823 | |
4824 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an | |
4825 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: > | |
4826 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:; | |
4827 | |
4828 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in | |
4829 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help| | |
4830 | |
4831 *'matchtime'* *'mat'* | |
4832 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5) | |
4833 global | |
4834 {not in Vi}{in Nvi} | |
4835 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is | |
4836 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that | |
4837 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi. | |
4838 | |
714 | 4839 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'* |
4840 'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2) | |
4841 global | |
4842 {not in Vi} | |
4843 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
4844 feature} | |
4845 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying. | |
4846 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8". | |
4847 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4. | |
4848 Maximum value is 6. | |
4849 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more | |
4850 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|. | |
4851 See |mbyte-combining|. | |
4852 | |
7 | 4853 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'* |
4854 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100) | |
4855 global | |
4856 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4857 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
1152 | 4858 feature} |
7 | 4859 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally |
4860 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with | |
4861 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use | |
4862 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted. | |
4863 See also |:function|. | |
4864 | |
4865 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223* | |
4866 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000) | |
4867 global | |
4868 {not in Vi} | |
4869 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a | |
4870 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like | |
4871 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg", | |
4872 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also | |
4873 |key-mapping|. | |
4874 | |
4875 *'maxmem'* *'mm'* | |
4876 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system | |
4877 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
4878 available) | |
4879 global | |
4880 {not in Vi} | |
4881 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this | |
4882 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4883 other memory to be freed. The maximum usable value is about 2000000. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4884 Use this to work without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'. |
7 | 4885 |
189 | 4886 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'* |
4887 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000) | |
4888 global | |
4889 {not in Vi} | |
4890 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4891 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. |
189 | 4892 *E363* |
1152 | 4893 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly |
4894 behaves like CTRL-C was typed. | |
189 | 4895 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very |
4896 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern | |
4897 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better. | |
4898 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit. | |
4899 | |
7 | 4900 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'* |
4901 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system | |
4902 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
4903 available) | |
4904 global | |
4905 {not in Vi} | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4906 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4907 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4908 without a limit. On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4909 hey, do you really need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4910 Also see 'maxmem'. |
7 | 4911 |
4912 *'menuitems'* *'mis'* | |
4913 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25) | |
4914 global | |
4915 {not in Vi} | |
4916 {not available when compiled without the |+menu| | |
4917 feature} | |
4918 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are | |
4919 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this | |
4920 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first. | |
4921 | |
484 | 4922 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'* |
4923 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500") | |
4924 global | |
4925 {not in Vi} | |
4926 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
4927 feature} | |
4928 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the | |
4929 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but | |
4930 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used | |
4931 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why | |
4932 this tuning is complicated. | |
4933 | |
4934 There are three numbers, separated by commas: | |
4935 {start},{inc},{added} | |
4936 | |
4937 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start} | |
4938 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any | |
4939 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of | |
4940 memory that is available to Vim. | |
4941 | |
4942 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the | |
4943 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another | |
4944 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after | |
4945 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory | |
4946 will be allocated. | |
4947 | |
4948 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before | |
4949 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra | |
4950 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller | |
4951 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's | |
4952 slower. | |
4953 | |
4954 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and | |
4955 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If | |
4956 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: > | |
4957 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800 | |
4958 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some | |
4959 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to. | |
4960 | |
7 | 4961 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'* |
1111 | 4962 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root), |
4963 Vi default: off) | |
7 | 4964 local to buffer |
4965 *'modelines'* *'mls'* | |
4966 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5) | |
4967 global | |
4968 {not in Vi} | |
4969 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is | |
4970 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero | |
4971 no lines are checked. See |modeline|. | |
4972 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
4973 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
4974 | |
4975 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'* | |
4976 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on) | |
4977 local to buffer | |
4978 {not in Vi} *E21* | |
4979 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and | |
4980 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed. | |
4981 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument. | |
4982 | |
4983 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'* | |
4984 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off) | |
4985 local to buffer | |
4986 {not in Vi} | |
4987 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set | |
4988 when: | |
4989 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the | |
4990 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the | |
4991 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the | |
4992 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from | |
4993 when it was written. | |
4994 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original | |
4995 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or | |
4996 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original | |
4997 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be | |
4998 reset. | |
3082 | 4999 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the |
5000 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost, | |
5001 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for | |
5002 an explanation. | |
7 | 5003 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but |
5004 will be ignored. | |
5005 | |
5006 *'more'* *'nomore'* | |
5007 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
5008 global | |
5009 {not in Vi} | |
5010 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get | |
5011 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the | |
5012 listing continues until finished. | |
5013 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
5014 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
5015 | |
5016 *'mouse'* *E538* | |
5017 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32) | |
5018 global | |
5019 {not in Vi} | |
5020 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals | |
1621 | 5021 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with |
5022 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the | |
5023 GUI, see |gui-mouse|. | |
7 | 5024 The mouse can be enabled for different modes: |
5025 n Normal mode | |
5026 v Visual mode | |
5027 i Insert mode | |
5028 c Command-line mode | |
5029 h all previous modes when editing a help file | |
5030 a all previous modes | |
5031 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt | |
5032 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: > | |
5033 :set mouse=a | |
5034 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for | |
5035 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor. | |
5036 | |
5037 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|. | |
5038 | |
5039 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the | |
10 | 5040 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of |
7 | 5041 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed. |
5042 Also see the 'clipboard' option. | |
5043 | |
5044 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'* | |
5045 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off) | |
5046 global | |
5047 {not in Vi} | |
5048 {only works in the GUI} | |
5049 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated. | |
5050 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the | |
5051 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the | |
5052 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as | |
5053 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally. | |
5054 | |
5055 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'* | |
5056 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on) | |
5057 global | |
5058 {not in Vi} | |
5059 {only works in the GUI} | |
5060 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed. | |
5061 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved. | |
5062 | |
5063 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'* | |
5064 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32) | |
5065 global | |
5066 {not in Vi} | |
5067 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what | |
5068 the right mouse button is used for: | |
5069 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works | |
5070 like in an xterm. | |
5071 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left | |
5072 mouse button extends a selection. This works like | |
233 | 5073 with Microsoft Windows. |
7 | 5074 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the |
5075 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the | |
5076 selected operation will act upon the clicked object. | |
5077 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will | |
233 | 5078 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of |
7 | 5079 course, that right clicking outside a selection will |
5080 end Visual mode. | |
5081 Overview of what button does what for each model: | |
5082 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~ | |
5083 left click place cursor place cursor | |
5084 left drag start selection start selection | |
5085 shift-left search word extend selection | |
5086 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor) | |
5087 right drag extend selection - | |
5088 middle click paste paste | |
5089 | |
5090 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu. | |
5091 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|. | |
5092 | |
5093 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings. | |
5094 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless | |
5095 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly). | |
5096 | |
5097 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
5098 | |
5099 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547* | |
5100 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross, | |
233 | 5101 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow") |
7 | 5102 global |
5103 {not in Vi} | |
5104 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape| | |
5105 feature} | |
5106 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in | |
5107 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much | |
5108 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list | |
5109 and an argument-list: | |
5110 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,.. | |
5111 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations: | |
5112 In a normal window: ~ | |
5113 n Normal mode | |
5114 v Visual mode | |
5115 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
5116 if not specified) | |
5117 o Operator-pending mode | |
5118 i Insert mode | |
5119 r Replace mode | |
5120 | |
5121 Others: ~ | |
5122 c appending to the command-line | |
5123 ci inserting in the command-line | |
5124 cr replacing in the command-line | |
5125 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts | |
5126 ml idem, but cursor in the last line | |
5127 e any mode, pointer below last window | |
5128 s any mode, pointer on a status line | |
5129 sd any mode, while dragging a status line | |
5130 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line | |
5131 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line | |
5132 a everywhere | |
5133 | |
5134 The shape is one of the following: | |
5135 avail name looks like ~ | |
5136 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer | |
5137 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!) | |
5138 w x beam I-beam | |
5139 w x updown up-down sizing arrows | |
5140 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows | |
5141 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer | |
5142 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer | |
5143 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing | |
5144 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing | |
5145 x crosshair like a big thin + | |
5146 x hand1 black hand | |
5147 x hand2 white hand | |
5148 x pencil what you write with | |
5149 x question big ? | |
5150 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up | |
5151 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up | |
5152 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h) | |
5153 | |
5154 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32, | |
5155 x for X11. | |
5156 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse | |
5157 pointer. | |
5158 | |
5159 Example: > | |
5160 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no | |
5161 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and | |
5162 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since | |
5163 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.) | |
5164 | |
5165 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'* | |
5166 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500) | |
5167 global | |
5168 {not in Vi} | |
5169 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum | |
5170 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be | |
5171 recognized as a multi click. | |
5172 | |
14 | 5173 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'* |
5174 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100) | |
5175 global | |
5176 {not in Vi} | |
5177 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme| | |
5178 feature} | |
5179 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads. | |
5180 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling. | |
5181 | |
7 | 5182 *'nrformats'* *'nf'* |
5183 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "octal,hex") | |
5184 local to buffer | |
5185 {not in Vi} | |
5186 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the | |
5187 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number | |
5188 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands. | |
625 | 5189 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be |
7 | 5190 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a |
3237 | 5191 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats* |
625 | 5192 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered |
7 | 5193 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010". |
625 | 5194 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be |
7 | 5195 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on |
5196 "0x100" results in "0x0ff". | |
5197 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always | |
5198 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not | |
5199 recognized as octal or hex. | |
5200 | |
5201 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'* | |
5202 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off) | |
5203 local to window | |
5204 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is | |
5205 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of | |
5206 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set). | |
13 | 5207 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
5208 number. | |
7 | 5209 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
5210 characters are put before the number. | |
3445 | 5211 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5212 the number. | |
4780 | 5213 *number_relativenumber* |
5214 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be | |
5215 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these | |
5216 four combinations (cursor in line 3): | |
5217 | |
5218 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu' | |
5219 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu' | |
5220 | |
5221 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple | |
5222 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear | |
5223 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody | |
5224 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there | |
7 | 5225 |
13 | 5226 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'* |
5227 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8) | |
5228 local to window | |
14 | 5229 {not in Vi} |
5230 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak| | |
5231 feature} | |
13 | 5232 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5233 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5234 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5235 the text, there is one less character for the number itself. |
13 | 5236 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5237 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5238 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5239 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5240 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used. |
13 | 5241 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10. |
5242 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set. | |
5243 | |
523 | 5244 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'* |
5245 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty) | |
502 | 5246 local to buffer |
5247 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5248 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5249 or |+insert_expand| features} |
623 | 5250 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni |
5251 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O| | |
648 | 5252 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
5253 invoked and what it should return. | |
1004 | 5254 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin: |
859 | 5255 |:filetype-plugin-on| |
3682 | 5256 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5257 security reasons. | |
502 | 5258 |
5259 | |
1152 | 5260 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'* |
1004 | 5261 'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off) |
5262 global | |
5263 {not in Vi} | |
5264 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2} | |
5265 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a | |
5266 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore | |
5267 it is off by default. | |
5268 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also | |
5269 result in editing a device. | |
5270 | |
5271 | |
593 | 5272 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'* |
5273 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty) | |
5274 global | |
5275 {not in Vi} | |
5276 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator. | |
5277 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example. | |
5278 | |
5279 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5280 security reasons. | |
5281 | |
5282 | |
2908 | 5283 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* |
5284 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "") | |
7 | 5285 local to buffer |
5286 {not in Vi} | |
2908 | 5287 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed. |
5288 | |
7 | 5289 |
5290 *'paragraphs'* *'para'* | |
1564 | 5291 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp") |
7 | 5292 global |
5293 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs | |
5294 of two letters (see |object-motions|). | |
5295 | |
5296 *'paste'* *'nopaste'* | |
5297 'paste' boolean (default off) | |
5298 global | |
5299 {not in Vi} | |
10 | 5300 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy |
5301 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid | |
7 | 5302 unexpected effects. |
5303 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim | |
10 | 5304 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim |
7 | 5305 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste' |
5306 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the | |
5307 mouse clicks itself. | |
148 | 5308 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in |
5309 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting | |
5310 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button | |
5311 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping. | |
7 | 5312 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on): |
5313 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled | |
5314 - abbreviations are disabled | |
5315 - 'textwidth' is set to 0 | |
5316 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0 | |
5317 - 'autoindent' is reset | |
5318 - 'smartindent' is reset | |
5319 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0 | |
5320 - 'revins' is reset | |
5321 - 'ruler' is reset | |
5322 - 'showmatch' is reset | |
5323 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty | |
5324 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled: | |
5325 - 'lisp' | |
5326 - 'indentexpr' | |
5327 - 'cindent' | |
5328 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is | |
5329 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the | |
5330 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to | |
5331 set the 'paste' option again. | |
5332 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to | |
5333 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on. | |
5334 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect. | |
5335 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use | |
5336 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key. | |
5337 | |
5338 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'* | |
5339 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "") | |
5340 global | |
5341 {not in Vi} | |
5342 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste' | |
5343 option. This is like specifying a mapping: > | |
5344 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR> | |
5345 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'. | |
5346 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set. | |
5347 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in | |
5348 Command-line mode. | |
5349 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However, | |
5350 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do | |
5351 this: > | |
5352 :map <F10> :set paste<CR> | |
5353 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR> | |
5354 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR> | |
5355 :imap <F11> <nop> | |
5356 :set pastetoggle=<F11> | |
5357 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode. | |
5358 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste | |
5359 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key | |
5360 sequence. | |
1621 | 5361 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies. |
7 | 5362 |
5363 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'* | |
5364 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "") | |
5365 global | |
5366 {not in Vi} | |
5367 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
5368 feature} | |
5369 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate | |
10 | 5370 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|. |
7 | 5371 |
6091
7090d7f160f7
Update runtime files. Add vroom file support.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6032
diff
changeset
|
5372 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206* |
7 | 5373 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "") |
5374 global | |
5375 {not in Vi} | |
5376 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used | |
5377 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a | |
5378 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a | |
5379 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the | |
5380 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option | |
5381 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like | |
5382 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The | |
5383 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has | |
5384 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a | |
5385 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is | |
5386 created. | |
5387 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made. | |
5388 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the | |
5389 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always | |
5390 recognized as a compressed file. | |
36 | 5391 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 5392 |
3224 | 5393 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854* |
7 | 5394 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,," |
5395 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,," | |
5396 other systems: ".,,") | |
5397 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
5398 {not in Vi} | |
5399 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
1668 | 5400 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands, |
5401 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not | |
5402 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path' | |
5403 option may be relative or absolute. | |
7 | 5404 - Use commas to separate directory names: > |
5405 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include | |
5406 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards | |
5407 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory | |
5408 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: > | |
5409 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space | |
5410 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra | |
5411 backslash: > | |
5412 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma | |
5413 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: > | |
5414 :set path=. | |
5415 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two | |
5416 commas: > | |
5417 :set path=,, | |
5418 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'. | |
5419 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
5420 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding | |
5421 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work. | |
1668 | 5422 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and |
5423 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax. | |
7 | 5424 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature} |
5425 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: > | |
5426 :set path=.,c:\\include | |
5427 < Or just use '/' instead: > | |
5428 :set path=.,c:/include | |
5429 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as | |
5430 the file! | |
10 | 5431 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly |
7 | 5432 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. |
5433 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of | |
5434 'path', see |:checkpath|. | |
5435 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
5436 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
5437 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: > | |
5438 :set path-= | |
5439 < To add the current directory use: > | |
5440 :set path+= | |
5441 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the | |
5442 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory | |
5443 names are separated with a semi-colon: > | |
5444 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g') | |
5445 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that | |
5446 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space. | |
5447 | |
5448 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'* | |
5449 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off) | |
5450 local to buffer | |
5451 {not in Vi} | |
5452 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the | |
5453 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a | |
5454 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is | |
5455 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option | |
5456 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible | |
5457 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required. | |
1621 | 5458 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains |
5459 a Tab. | |
7 | 5460 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of |
5461 tabs and spaces. You might not like this. | |
5462 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
5463 Also see 'copyindent'. | |
5464 Use |:retab| to clean up white space. | |
5465 | |
5466 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'* | |
5467 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12) | |
5468 global | |
5469 {not in Vi} | |
5470 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5471 |+quickfix| features} |
7 | 5472 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated |
5473 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given. | |
5474 | |
5475 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'* | |
5476 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590* | |
5477 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off) | |
5478 local to window | |
5479 {not in Vi} | |
5480 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5481 |+quickfix| features} |
10 | 5482 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option |
7 | 5483 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands |
5484 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc. | |
5485 | |
5486 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'* | |
5487 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty) | |
5488 global | |
5489 {not in Vi} | |
5490 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5491 feature} | |
15 | 5492 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5493 See |pdev-option|. | |
36 | 5494 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5495 security reasons. | |
15 | 5496 |
5497 *'printencoding'* *'penc'* | |
5498 'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems) | |
7 | 5499 global |
5500 {not in Vi} | |
5501 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5502 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5503 Sets the character encoding used when printing. |
5504 See |penc-option|. | |
7 | 5505 |
5506 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'* | |
5507 'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below) | |
5508 global | |
5509 {not in Vi} | |
5510 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5511 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5512 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|. |
5513 See |pexpr-option|. | |
5514 | |
5515 *'printfont'* *'pfn'* | |
7 | 5516 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier") |
5517 global | |
5518 {not in Vi} | |
5519 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5520 feature} | |
15 | 5521 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5522 See |pfn-option|. | |
7 | 5523 |
5524 *'printheader'* *'pheader'* | |
5525 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N") | |
5526 global | |
5527 {not in Vi} | |
5528 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5529 feature} | |
15 | 5530 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output. |
5531 See |pheader-option|. | |
5532 | |
5533 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'* | |
5534 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "") | |
5535 global | |
5536 {not in Vi} | |
180 | 5537 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|, |
5538 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features} | |
15 | 5539 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5540 See |pmbcs-option|. | |
5541 | |
5542 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'* | |
5543 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "") | |
5544 global | |
5545 {not in Vi} | |
180 | 5546 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|, |
5547 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features} | |
15 | 5548 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5549 See |pmbfn-option|. | |
7 | 5550 |
5551 *'printoptions'* *'popt'* | |
5552 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "") | |
5553 global | |
5554 {not in Vi} | |
5555 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature} | |
15 | 5556 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|. |
5557 See |popt-option|. | |
5558 | |
168 | 5559 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'* |
5560 'prompt' boolean (default on) | |
5561 global | |
5562 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode. | |
5563 | |
766 | 5564 *'pumheight'* *'ph'* |
5565 'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0) | |
5566 global | |
5567 {not available when compiled without the | |
5568 |+insert_expand| feature} | |
5569 {not in Vi} | |
853 | 5570 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for |
5571 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used. | |
766 | 5572 |ins-completion-menu|. |
5573 | |
5574 | |
140 | 5575 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'* |
12 | 5576 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\") |
5577 local to buffer | |
5578 {not in Vi} | |
5579 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for | |
5580 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|. | |
5581 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string, | |
5582 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the | |
5583 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string. | |
5584 | |
7 | 5585 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'* |
5586 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off) | |
5587 local to buffer | |
5588 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from | |
5589 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started | |
5590 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view". | |
164 | 5591 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current |
5592 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'. | |
7 | 5593 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is |
164 | 5594 set for the newly edited buffer. |
7 | 5595 |
1521 | 5596 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'* |
5597 'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000) | |
5598 global | |
5599 {not in Vi} | |
5600 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime| | |
5601 feature} | |
5602 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to | |
5603 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch' and |:match| highlighting. | |
5604 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further | |
5605 matches will be highlighted. This is used to avoid that Vim hangs | |
5606 when using a very complicated pattern. | |
5607 | |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5608 *'regexpengine'* *'re'* |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5609 'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0) |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5610 global |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5611 {not in Vi} |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5612 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines| |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5613 The possible values are: |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5614 0 automatic selection |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5615 1 old engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5616 2 NFA engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5617 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5618 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5619 for debugging the regexp engine. |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5620 |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5621 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'* |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5622 'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off) |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5623 local to window |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5624 {not in Vi} |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5625 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2204
diff
changeset
|
5626 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5627 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5628 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5629 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5630 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5631 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5632 'compatible' isn't set). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5633 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5634 number. |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5635 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5636 characters are put before the number. |
3445 | 5637 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5638 the number. | |
4780 | 5639 |
5640 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of | |
5641 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two | |
5642 options. | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5643 |
7 | 5644 *'remap'* *'noremap'* |
5645 'remap' boolean (default on) | |
5646 global | |
5647 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for | |
5648 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command. | |
717 | 5649 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep |
5650 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with | |
5651 old Vi scripts. | |
7 | 5652 |
5653 *'report'* | |
5654 'report' number (default 2) | |
5655 global | |
5656 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of | |
5657 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most | |
5658 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0. | |
5659 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used | |
5660 instead of the number of lines. | |
5661 | |
5662 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'* | |
5663 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on) | |
5664 global | |
5665 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version} | |
5666 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also | |
5667 happens when executing external commands. | |
5668 | |
5669 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te' | |
5670 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring: | |
5671 set t_ti= t_te= | |
5672 To enable restoring (for an xterm): | |
5673 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8 | |
5674 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it) | |
5675 | |
5676 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'* | |
5677 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off) | |
5678 global | |
5679 {not in Vi} | |
5680 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
5681 feature} | |
5682 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing | |
5683 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_ | |
5684 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set. | |
5685 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' or 'paste' is set. | |
5686 | |
5687 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'* | |
5688 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off) | |
5689 local to window | |
5690 {not in Vi} | |
5691 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
5692 feature} | |
5693 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters | |
5694 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left. | |
5695 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that | |
5696 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic. | |
5697 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files | |
5698 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is | |
5699 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left | |
5700 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly | |
5701 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|. | |
5702 | |
2341 | 5703 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* |
7 | 5704 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search") |
5705 local to window | |
5706 {not in Vi} | |
5707 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
5708 feature} | |
5709 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in | |
5710 right-to-left mode for a group of commands: | |
5711 | |
5712 search "/" and "?" commands | |
5713 | |
5714 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi. | |
5715 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect. | |
5716 | |
5717 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'* | |
5718 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off) | |
5719 global | |
5720 {not in Vi} | |
5721 {not available when compiled without the | |
5722 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
5723 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a | |
10 | 5724 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed |
7 | 5725 text in the file is shown on the far right: |
5726 Top first line is visible | |
5727 Bot last line is visible | |
5728 All first and last line are visible | |
5729 45% relative position in the file | |
5730 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler. | |
10 | 5731 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the |
7 | 5732 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the |
233 | 5733 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty), |
7 | 5734 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat' |
5735 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of | |
5736 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both | |
5737 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown, | |
5738 separated with a dash. | |
5739 For an empty line "0-1" is shown. | |
5740 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1". | |
5741 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set. | |
5742 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where | |
5743 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|. | |
5744 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
5745 | |
5746 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'* | |
5747 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty) | |
5748 global | |
5749 {not in Vi} | |
5750 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| | |
5751 feature} | |
5752 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler | |
5753 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option. | |
692 | 5754 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
7 | 5755 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15 |
5756 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end. | |
5757 Example: > | |
5758 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%) | |
5759 < | |
5760 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles* | |
5761 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default: | |
5762 Unix: "$HOME/.vim, | |
5763 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
5764 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
5765 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
5766 $HOME/.vim/after" | |
5767 Amiga: "home:vimfiles, | |
5768 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
5769 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
5770 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
5771 home:vimfiles/after" | |
5772 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles, | |
5773 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
5774 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
5775 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
5776 $HOME/vimfiles/after" | |
5777 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles, | |
5778 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
5779 $VIM:vimfiles:after" | |
5780 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles, | |
5781 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
5782 Choices:vimfiles/after" | |
5783 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles, | |
5784 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
5785 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
5786 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
233 | 5787 sys$login:vimfiles/after") |
7 | 5788 global |
5789 {not in Vi} | |
5790 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime | |
5791 files: | |
5792 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype| | |
5793 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts| | |
164 | 5794 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions| |
7 | 5795 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme| |
5796 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler| | |
5797 doc/ documentation |write-local-help| | |
5798 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin| | |
5799 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression| | |
5800 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap| | |
5801 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans| | |
5802 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim| | |
5803 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin| | |
5804 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding| | |
650 | 5805 spell/ spell checking files |spell| |
7 | 5806 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile| |
5807 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor| | |
5808 | |
5809 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command. | |
5810 | |
5811 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations: | |
5812 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences. | |
5813 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system | |
5814 administrator. | |
5815 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim. | |
5816 *after-directory* | |
5817 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is | |
5818 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed | |
5819 defaults (rarely needed) | |
5820 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for | |
5821 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults | |
5822 or system-wide settings (rarely needed). | |
5823 | |
5824 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal | |
5825 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for | |
10 | 5826 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid |
7 | 5827 wildcards. |
5828 See |:runtime|. | |
5829 Example: > | |
5830 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME | |
5831 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your | |
5832 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a | |
5833 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime | |
5834 files). | |
5835 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the | |
5836 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME | |
5837 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put | |
5838 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed | |
5839 runtime files. | |
5840 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5841 security reasons. | |
5842 | |
5843 *'scroll'* *'scr'* | |
5844 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height) | |
5845 local to window | |
5846 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be | |
5847 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size | |
5848 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will | |
10 | 5849 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window |
7 | 5850 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives |
5851 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference | |
5852 when lines wrap} | |
5853 | |
5854 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'* | |
5855 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off) | |
5856 local to window | |
5857 {not in Vi} | |
5858 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind| | |
5859 feature} | |
5860 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current | |
5861 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have | |
5862 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the | |
5863 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'. | |
5864 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be | |
5865 interpreted. | |
5866 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another | |
5867 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows | |
5868 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not. | |
5869 | |
5870 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'* | |
5871 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1) | |
5872 global | |
5873 {not in Vi} | |
5874 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the | |
5875 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E, | |
5876 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly. | |
532 | 5877 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the |
5878 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window | |
5879 height. | |
7 | 5880 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set. |
5881 | |
5882 *'scrolloff'* *'so'* | |
5883 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0) | |
5884 global | |
5885 {not in Vi} | |
5886 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor. | |
5887 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If | |
5888 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be | |
5889 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or | |
5890 when long lines wrap). | |
5891 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'. | |
5892 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
5893 | |
5894 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'* | |
5895 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump") | |
5896 global | |
5897 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind| | |
5898 feature} | |
5899 {not in Vi} | |
5900 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how | |
236 | 5901 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind |
5902 Options. | |
7 | 5903 The following words are available: |
5904 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
5905 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
5906 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical | |
5907 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first | |
5908 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving | |
5909 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may | |
5910 reach a position before the start or after the end of | |
5911 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when | |
5912 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll | |
5913 to the desired position when possible. | |
5914 When now making that window the current one, two | |
5915 things can be done with the relative offset: | |
5916 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is | |
5917 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current | |
5918 window. When going back to the other window, the | |
1152 | 5919 new relative offset will be used. |
7 | 5920 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are |
5921 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When | |
5922 going back to the other window, it still uses the | |
5923 same relative offset. | |
5924 Also see |scroll-binding|. | |
819 | 5925 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding, |
5926 even when "ver" isn't there. | |
7 | 5927 |
5928 *'sections'* *'sect'* | |
5929 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh") | |
5930 global | |
5931 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of | |
5932 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start | |
5933 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh". | |
5934 | |
5935 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523* | |
5936 'secure' boolean (default off) | |
5937 global | |
5938 {not in Vi} | |
5939 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in | |
5940 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are | |
5941 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into | |
5942 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is | |
5943 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be | |
10 | 5944 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set |
7 | 5945 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then. |
5946 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5947 security reasons. | |
5948 | |
5949 *'selection'* *'sel'* | |
5950 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive") | |
5951 global | |
5952 {not in Vi} | |
5953 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used | |
5954 in Visual and Select mode. | |
5955 Possible values: | |
5956 value past line inclusive ~ | |
5957 old no yes | |
5958 inclusive yes yes | |
5959 exclusive yes no | |
5960 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one | |
5961 character past the line. | |
5962 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included | |
5963 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the | |
5964 selection. | |
5965 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end | |
5966 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when | |
5967 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty. | |
5968 | |
5969 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
5970 | |
5971 *'selectmode'* *'slm'* | |
5972 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "") | |
5973 global | |
5974 {not in Vi} | |
5975 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start | |
5976 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started. | |
5977 Possible values: | |
5978 mouse when using the mouse | |
5979 key when using shifted special keys | |
5980 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V | |
5981 See |Select-mode|. | |
5982 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
5983 | |
5984 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'* | |
5985 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds, | |
827 | 5986 help,options,tabpages,winsize") |
7 | 5987 global |
5988 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5989 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 5990 feature} |
5991 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma | |
5992 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring | |
5993 something: | |
5994 word save and restore ~ | |
5995 blank empty windows | |
5996 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows | |
5997 curdir the current directory | |
5998 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
5999 fold options | |
6000 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter | |
75 | 6001 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only |
6002 String and Number types are stored. | |
7 | 6003 help the help window |
6004 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
6005 global values for local options) | |
6006 options all options and mappings (also global values for local | |
6007 options) | |
6008 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns' | |
6009 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located | |
6010 will become the current directory (useful with | |
6011 projects accessed over a network from different | |
6012 systems) | |
6013 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward | |
6014 slashes | |
827 | 6015 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page |
6016 is restored, so that you can make a session for each | |
6017 tab page separately | |
7 | 6018 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when |
6019 on Windows or DOS | |
6020 winpos position of the whole Vim window | |
6021 winsize window sizes | |
6022 | |
6023 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir". | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6024 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6025 with absolute paths. |
7 | 6026 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files |
6027 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, | |
6028 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. | |
6029 | |
6030 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91* | |
6031 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh", | |
6032 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or | |
6033 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd") | |
6034 global | |
6035 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the | |
6036 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash' | |
6037 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'. | |
10 | 6038 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f". |
7 | 6039 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
6040 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
6041 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose | |
6042 it in quotes. Example: > | |
6043 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f | |
6044 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and | |
10 | 6045 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the |
7 | 6046 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command |
6047 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path | |
6048 separators. | |
6049 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment | |
6050 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the | |
6051 libc.inf file of DJGPP. | |
6052 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be | |
6053 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com" | |
6054 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g., | |
6055 filtering). | |
6056 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is | |
6057 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: > | |
6058 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos | |
6059 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6060 security reasons. | |
6061 | |
6062 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'* | |
3356 | 6063 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c"; |
3371 | 6064 MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' does not |
6065 contain "sh" somewhere: "/c") | |
7 | 6066 global |
6067 {not in Vi} | |
6068 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g., | |
6069 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like | |
6070 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to | |
6071 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for | |
3082 | 6072 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself). |
6073 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated | |
6074 part is passed as an argument to the shell command. | |
6075 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
6076 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-DOS and MS-Windows. | |
7 | 6077 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6078 security reasons. | |
6079 | |
6080 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'* | |
6081 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee") | |
6082 global | |
6083 {not in Vi} | |
6084 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
6085 feature} | |
6086 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the | |
10 | 6087 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about |
7 | 6088 including spaces and backslashes. |
6089 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6090 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6091 of this option). | |
6092 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly | |
6093 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen. | |
6094 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved | |
6095 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or | |
6096 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the | |
2788 | 6097 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh" or "bash" the |
6098 default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included. | |
6099 Before using the 'shell' option a path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses | |
6100 "sh". | |
7 | 6101 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" |
6102 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6103 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was | |
6104 explicitly set before. | |
6105 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the | |
6106 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg' | |
6107 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do | |
6108 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space. | |
6109 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ". | |
6110 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6111 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6112 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6113 security reasons. | |
6114 | |
6115 *'shellquote'* *'shq'* | |
6116 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' | |
6117 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"") | |
6118 global | |
6119 {not in Vi} | |
6120 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6121 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the | |
6122 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's | |
6123 probably not useful to set both options. | |
6124 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for | |
6125 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell | |
6126 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according | |
6127 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the | |
6128 user. See |dos-shell|. | |
6129 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6130 security reasons. | |
6131 | |
6132 *'shellredir'* *'srr'* | |
6133 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1") | |
6134 global | |
6135 {not in Vi} | |
6136 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary | |
6137 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces | |
6138 and backslashes. | |
6139 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6140 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6141 of this option). | |
6142 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh" | |
6143 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the | |
6144 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes | |
6145 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included. | |
6146 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked | |
6147 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with | |
6148 ".exe" appended are checked for. | |
6149 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" | |
6150 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6151 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was | |
6152 explicitly set before. | |
6153 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6154 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6155 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6156 security reasons. | |
6157 | |
6158 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'* | |
6159 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off) | |
6160 global | |
6161 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2} | |
6162 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is | |
6163 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or | |
6164 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to | |
6165 forward slashes by Vim. | |
6166 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some | |
6167 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening | |
6168 any file for best results. This might change in the future. | |
6169 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path | |
6170 separator. To test if this is so use: > | |
6171 if exists('+shellslash') | |
6172 < | |
168 | 6173 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'* |
6174 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on) | |
6175 global | |
6176 {not in Vi} | |
6177 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe. | |
6178 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway. | |
2965 | 6179 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and |
6180 later. You can check it with: > | |
168 | 6181 :if has("filterpipe") |
6182 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file | |
6183 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection. | |
6184 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding | |
6185 can be detected. | |
6186 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|, | |
6187 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when | |
6188 'shelltemp' is off. | |
6189 | |
7 | 6190 *'shelltype'* *'st'* |
6191 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0) | |
6192 global | |
6193 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga} | |
6194 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work | |
6195 which use a shell. | |
6196 0 and 1: always use the shell | |
6197 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines | |
6198 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command | |
6199 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly. | |
6200 | |
6201 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands | |
6202 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands | |
6203 | |
3371 | 6204 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'* |
6205 'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: ""; | |
6206 for MS-DOS and MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^") | |
6207 global | |
6208 {not in Vi} | |
6209 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this | |
6210 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible | |
6211 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe. | |
6212 | |
7 | 6213 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'* |
6214 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: ""; | |
3359 | 6215 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "(" |
6216 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh" | |
6217 somewhere: "\"" | |
7 | 6218 for Unix, when using system(): "\"") |
6219 global | |
6220 {not in Vi} | |
6221 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6222 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See | |
6223 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful | |
6224 to set both options. | |
3359 | 6225 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"(' |
6226 then ')"' is appended. | |
6227 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'. | |
3352 | 6228 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be |
6229 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically | |
6230 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells | |
6231 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The | |
6232 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need | |
6233 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|. | |
7 | 6234 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6235 security reasons. | |
6236 | |
6237 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'* | |
6238 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off) | |
6239 global | |
6240 {not in Vi} | |
6241 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and < | |
6242 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to | |
6243 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible). | |
6244 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6245 | |
6246 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'* | |
6247 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8) | |
6248 local to buffer | |
10 | 6249 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for |
7 | 6250 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc. |
3893 | 6251 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()| |
6252 function to get the effective shiftwidth value. | |
7 | 6253 |
6254 *'shortmess'* *'shm'* | |
168 | 6255 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "", |
6256 POSIX default: "A") | |
7 | 6257 global |
6258 {not in Vi} | |
6259 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file | |
6260 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages. | |
6261 It is a list of flags: | |
6262 flag meaning when present ~ | |
6263 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)" | |
6264 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]" | |
6265 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters" | |
6266 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]" | |
6267 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]" | |
6268 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]" | |
6269 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message | |
6270 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command | |
6271 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of | |
6272 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]". | |
6273 a all of the above abbreviations | |
6274 | |
6275 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message | |
6276 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on) | |
6277 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message. | |
6278 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn"). | |
6279 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search | |
6280 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages | |
6281 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit | |
6282 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column. | |
6283 Ignored in Ex mode. | |
6284 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to | |
233 | 6285 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle. |
7 | 6286 Ignored in Ex mode. |
6287 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file | |
6288 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file | |
6289 is found. | |
6290 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|. | |
5946 | 6291 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example, |
6292 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match", | |
6293 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc. | |
7 | 6294 |
6295 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers | |
6296 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as | |
6297 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you | |
6298 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!" | |
6299 Useful values: | |
6300 shm= No abbreviation of message. | |
6301 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information. | |
6302 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary. | |
6303 | |
6304 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6305 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6306 | |
6307 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'* | |
6308 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off) | |
6309 local to buffer | |
6310 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions} | |
6311 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3 | |
6312 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this | |
6313 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when | |
6314 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available | |
6315 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful | |
6316 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos | |
6317 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this | |
6318 option is always on by default. | |
6319 | |
6320 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595* | |
6321 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "") | |
6322 global | |
6323 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6324 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 6325 feature} |
6326 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6327 values are "> " or "+++ ": > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6328 :set showbreak=>\ |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6329 < Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6330 this: > |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
6331 :let &showbreak = '+++ ' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6332 < Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and |
7 | 6333 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the |
6334 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line). | |
6335 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in | |
6336 'highlight'. | |
6337 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently. | |
6338 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the | |
6339 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'. | |
6340 | |
6341 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'* | |
6342 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, Vi default: | |
6343 off) | |
6344 global | |
6345 {not in Vi} | |
6346 {not available when compiled without the | |
6347 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
1152 | 6348 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this |
6349 option off if your terminal is slow. | |
7 | 6350 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown: |
6351 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters. | |
2324
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6352 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6" |
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6353 means two characters and six bytes. |
7 | 6354 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6355 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6356 {lines}x{columns}. |
7 | 6357 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
6358 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6359 | |
6360 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'* | |
6361 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off) | |
6362 global | |
6363 {not in Vi} | |
6364 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the | |
6365 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search | |
10 | 6366 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have |
7 | 6367 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are |
6368 required (coding style permitting). | |
1621 | 6369 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in |
6370 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not | |
6371 match the typed text. | |
7 | 6372 |
6373 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'* | |
6374 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off) | |
6375 global | |
6376 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The | |
6377 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to | |
6378 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'. | |
6379 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be | |
6380 seen or not). This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set. | |
6381 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character | |
6382 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs. | |
6383 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and | |
6384 blinking when showing the match. | |
6385 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show | |
6386 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite | |
6387 matches. | |
699 | 6388 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving |
6389 around |pi_paren.txt|. | |
6390 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG. | |
7 | 6391 |
6392 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'* | |
6393 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
6394 global | |
6395 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line. | |
6396 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for | |
6397 this message. | |
10 | 6398 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this |
7 | 6399 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is |
6400 not set. | |
6401 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6402 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6403 | |
677 | 6404 *'showtabline'* *'stal'* |
6405 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1) | |
6406 global | |
6407 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6408 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
677 | 6409 feature} |
6410 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels | |
6411 will be displayed: | |
6412 0: never | |
6413 1: only if there are at least two tab pages | |
6414 2: always | |
6415 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages | |
6416 line. | |
6417 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages. | |
6418 | |
7 | 6419 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'* |
6420 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0) | |
6421 global | |
6422 {not in Vi} | |
6423 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when | |
6424 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen. | |
6425 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen. | |
6426 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using | |
6427 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl" | |
6428 commands. | |
6429 | |
6430 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'* | |
6431 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0) | |
6432 global | |
6433 {not in Vi} | |
6434 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the | |
534 | 6435 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a |
6436 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero | |
6437 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in | |
6438 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option | |
6439 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor | |
6440 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too | |
6441 close to the beginning of the line. | |
7 | 6442 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
6443 | |
6444 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as | |
6445 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move | |
6446 onto the "extends" character: | |
6447 | |
6448 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:< | |
6449 :set sidescrolloff=1 | |
6450 | |
6451 | |
6452 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'* | |
6453 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off) | |
6454 global | |
6455 {not in Vi} | |
6456 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper | |
6457 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and | |
6458 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N", | |
3557 | 6459 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After |
7 | 6460 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command, |
6461 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>. | |
6462 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6463 | |
6464 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'* | |
6465 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off) | |
6466 local to buffer | |
6467 {not in Vi} | |
6468 {not available when compiled without the | |
6469 |+smartindent| feature} | |
6470 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like | |
6471 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does | |
6472 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict, | |
2662 | 6473 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set, |
2642 | 6474 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced |
6475 alternative. | |
7 | 6476 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'. |
6477 An indent is automatically inserted: | |
6478 - After a line ending in '{'. | |
6479 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'. | |
6480 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command). | |
6481 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is | |
6482 given the same indent as the matching '{'. | |
6483 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for | |
6484 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent | |
10 | 6485 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this |
7 | 6486 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H. |
6487 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted | |
6488 right. | |
10 | 6489 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. When 'paste' |
7 | 6490 is set smart indenting is disabled. |
6491 | |
6492 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'* | |
6493 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off) | |
6494 global | |
6495 {not in Vi} | |
6496 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to | |
648 | 6497 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A |
6498 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the | |
6499 line. | |
650 | 6500 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or |
648 | 6501 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or |
6502 right |shift-left-right|. | |
1263 | 6503 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab' |
7 | 6504 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the |
11 | 6505 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. |
7 | 6506 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
6507 | |
6508 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'* | |
6509 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0) | |
6510 local to buffer | |
6511 {not in Vi} | |
6512 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing | |
6513 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like | |
6514 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is | |
6515 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value | |
6516 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However, | |
6517 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters. | |
6518 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off. | |
3893 | 6519 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used. |
7 | 6520 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. |
6521 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of | |
6522 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. | |
6523 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is | |
6524 set. | |
6525 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
6526 | |
221 | 6527 *'spell'* *'nospell'* |
6528 'spell' boolean (default off) | |
6529 local to window | |
6530 {not in Vi} | |
6531 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6532 feature} | |
6533 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|. | |
236 | 6534 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'. |
221 | 6535 |
386 | 6536 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'* |
389 | 6537 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+") |
386 | 6538 local to buffer |
6539 {not in Vi} | |
6540 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6541 feature} | |
6542 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be | |
6543 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted | |
484 | 6544 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled). |
386 | 6545 When this check is not wanted make this option empty. |
6546 Only used when 'spell' is set. | |
389 | 6547 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about |
6548 including spaces and backslashes. | |
480 | 6549 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see |
6550 |set-spc-auto|. | |
386 | 6551 |
314 | 6552 *'spellfile'* *'spf'* |
6553 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty) | |
6554 local to buffer | |
6555 {not in Vi} | |
6556 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6557 feature} | |
6558 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw| | |
401 | 6559 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the |
6560 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory. | |
386 | 6561 *E765* |
6562 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the | |
6563 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using | |
6564 a personal word list file and a project word list file. | |
314 | 6565 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for |
819 | 6566 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If |
6567 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file | |
6568 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used, | |
353 | 6569 ignoring the region. |
6570 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not | |
6571 have to appear in 'spelllang'. | |
6572 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region | |
6573 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when | |
6574 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files | |
6575 without region name will be found. | |
336 | 6576 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6577 security reasons. | |
314 | 6578 |
221 | 6579 *'spelllang'* *'spl'* |
314 | 6580 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en") |
221 | 6581 local to buffer |
6582 {not in Vi} | |
6583 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6584 feature} | |
353 | 6585 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is |
6586 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: > | |
6587 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical | |
6588 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words | |
6589 that are not recognized will be highlighted. | |
6590 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is | |
6591 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a | |
6592 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words. | |
6593 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is | |
6594 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one | |
6595 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian | |
6596 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great | |
6597 Britain. | |
5477 | 6598 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from |
6599 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian | |
6600 words. | |
484 | 6601 *E757* |
419 | 6602 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The |
6603 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name | |
6604 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter). | |
6605 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct | |
6606 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it. | |
236 | 6607 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good |
419 | 6608 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the |
6609 files twice. | |
353 | 6610 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|. |
221 | 6611 |
653 | 6612 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name |
6613 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin | |
6614 will ask you if you want to download the file. | |
6615 | |
480 | 6616 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files |
6617 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang' | |
650 | 6618 up to the first comma, dot or underscore. |
6619 Also see |set-spc-auto|. | |
480 | 6620 |
6621 | |
344 | 6622 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'* |
6623 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best") | |
6624 global | |
6625 {not in Vi} | |
6626 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6627 feature} | |
593 | 6628 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and |
374 | 6629 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of |
6630 items: | |
6631 | |
6632 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds | |
6633 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like | |
6634 scoring to improve the ordering. | |
6635 | |
6636 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the | |
6637 results. The first method is "fast", the other method | |
344 | 6638 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad |
374 | 6639 word. That only works when the language specifies |
6640 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give | |
6641 better results. | |
6642 | |
6643 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes: | |
6644 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for | |
6645 simple typing mistakes. | |
6646 | |
593 | 6647 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|. |
484 | 6648 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of |
6649 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines' | |
6650 minus two. | |
6651 | |
374 | 6652 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns, |
6653 separated by a slash. The first column contains the | |
6654 bad word, the second column the suggested good word. | |
6655 Example: | |
6656 theribal/terrible ~ | |
6657 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the | |
6658 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods. | |
6659 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for | |
6660 comments. | |
5862 | 6661 The word in the second column must be correct, |
6662 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an | |
6663 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling | |
6664 mistake. | |
374 | 6665 The file is used for all languages. |
6666 | |
6667 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid | |
6668 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled | |
6669 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of | |
6670 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score. | |
6671 Example: | |
6672 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] | |
593 | 6673 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the |
374 | 6674 internal methods use. A lower score is better. |
6675 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily | |
6676 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part. | |
6677 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the | |
6678 'verbose' option to a non-zero value. | |
6679 | |
6680 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may | |
6681 appear several times in any order. Example: > | |
6682 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest() | |
6683 < | |
6684 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6685 security reasons. | |
344 | 6686 |
6687 | |
7 | 6688 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'* |
6689 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off) | |
6690 global | |
6691 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6692 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 6693 feature} |
6694 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current | |
6695 one. |:split| | |
6696 | |
6697 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'* | |
6698 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off) | |
6699 global | |
6700 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6701 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 6702 feature} |
6703 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the | |
6704 current one. |:vsplit| | |
6705 | |
6706 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'* | |
6707 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on) | |
6708 global | |
6709 {not in Vi} | |
6710 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first | |
11 | 6711 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column |
10 | 6712 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B, |
11 | 6713 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>" |
7 | 6714 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing |
6715 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that | |
6716 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+". | |
6717 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column | |
6718 where it was the last time the buffer was edited. | |
6719 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
6720 | |
2709 | 6721 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542* |
7 | 6722 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty) |
40 | 6723 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 6724 {not in Vi} |
6725 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| | |
6726 feature} | |
6727 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line. | |
6728 Also see |status-line|. | |
6729 | |
6730 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with | |
6731 normal text. Each status line item is of the form: | |
6732 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item} | |
6733 All fields except the {item} is optional. A single percent sign can | |
2709 | 6734 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541* |
7 | 6735 |
680 | 6736 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression, |
6737 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: > | |
6738 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine() | |
6739 < The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too. | |
3445 | 6740 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the |
6741 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the | |
6742 context of the window that the statusline belongs to. | |
680 | 6743 |
6744 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made | |
6745 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop. | |
6746 | |
7 | 6747 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and |
6748 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|. | |
6749 | |
6750 field meaning ~ | |
233 | 6751 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified |
7 | 6752 when minwid is larger than the length of the item. |
233 | 6753 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'. |
7 | 6754 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'. |
6755 Value must be 50 or less. | |
10 | 6756 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<' |
7 | 6757 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be |
6758 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number | |
6759 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like | |
6760 an exponential notation. | |
6761 item A one letter code as described below. | |
6762 | |
6763 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The | |
6764 second character in "item" is the type: | |
6765 N for number | |
6766 S for string | |
6767 F for flags as described below | |
6768 - not applicable | |
6769 | |
6770 item meaning ~ | |
1152 | 6771 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current |
6772 directory. | |
7 | 6773 F S Full path to the file in the buffer. |
6774 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer. | |
1698 | 6775 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off. |
7 | 6776 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-". |
1698 | 6777 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]". |
7 | 6778 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO". |
1698 | 6779 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]". |
7 | 6780 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP". |
1698 | 6781 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]". |
7 | 6782 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV". |
1698 | 6783 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'. |
7 | 6784 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'. |
6785 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature} | |
2411
68e394361ca3
Add "q" item for 'statusline'. Add w:quickfix_title. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2400
diff
changeset
|
6786 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty. |
7 | 6787 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are |
6788 being used: "<keymap>" | |
6789 n N Buffer number. | |
2709 | 6790 b N Value of character under cursor. |
7 | 6791 B N As above, in hexadecimal. |
6792 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1. | |
6793 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added) | |
6794 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature} | |
6795 O N As above, in hexadecimal. | |
233 | 6796 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.) |
7 | 6797 l N Line number. |
6798 L N Number of lines in buffer. | |
6799 c N Column number. | |
6800 v N Virtual column number. | |
10 | 6801 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'. |
7 | 6802 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|. |
6803 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the | |
5055 | 6804 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless |
6805 translated. | |
233 | 6806 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max}) |
7 | 6807 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one. |
680 | 6808 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result. |
625 | 6809 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. |
7 | 6810 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and |
6811 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere. | |
6812 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed. | |
681 | 6813 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last |
6814 label. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
6815 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the | |
6816 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab" | |
6817 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
7 | 6818 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start. |
6819 No width fields allowed. | |
6820 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items. | |
6821 No width fields allowed. | |
680 | 6822 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again. |
6823 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same | |
6824 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current | |
6825 windows. | |
7 | 6826 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the |
233 | 6827 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*. |
7 | 6828 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied |
6829 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows. | |
6830 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9| | |
6831 | |
1698 | 6832 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when |
6833 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display | |
6834 when flags are used like in the examples below. | |
7 | 6835 |
233 | 6836 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are |
7 | 6837 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will |
6838 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear | |
6839 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. > | |
6840 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)... | |
6841 < | |
6842 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status | |
6843 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set | |
6844 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is | |
233 | 6845 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context. |
7 | 6846 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the |
634 | 6847 real current buffer. |
6848 | |
3682 | 6849 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from |
6850 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
634 | 6851 |
6852 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
6853 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|. | |
7 | 6854 |
6855 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting | |
6856 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by | |
6857 setting an option without changing its value. Example: > | |
6858 :let &ro = &ro | |
6859 | |
6860 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes. | |
6861 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules | |
6862 described above. | |
6863 | |
199 | 6864 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable! |
7 | 6865 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and |
6866 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right. | |
6867 | |
6868 Examples: | |
6869 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set > | |
6870 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P | |
6871 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") > | |
6872 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P | |
6873 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. > | |
6874 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b' | |
6875 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red | |
6876 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded > | |
6877 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h... | |
6878 < In the |:autocmd|'s: > | |
6879 :let b:gzflag = 1 | |
6880 < And: > | |
6881 :unlet b:gzflag | |
6882 < And define this function: > | |
6883 :function VarExists(var, val) | |
6884 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif | |
6885 :endfunction | |
6886 < | |
6887 *'suffixes'* *'su'* | |
6888 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj") | |
6889 global | |
6890 {not in Vi} | |
6891 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files | |
6892 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the | |
10 | 6893 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as |
6894 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a | |
7 | 6895 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about |
6896 including spaces and backslashes). | |
6897 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files. | |
6898 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
6899 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
6900 uses another default. | |
6901 | |
6902 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'* | |
6903 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "") | |
6904 local to buffer | |
6905 {not in Vi} | |
6906 {not available when compiled without the | |
6907 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
6908 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a | |
6909 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: > | |
6910 :set suffixesadd=.java | |
6911 < | |
6912 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'* | |
6913 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on) | |
6914 local to buffer | |
6915 {not in Vi} | |
10 | 6916 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a |
7 | 6917 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with |
6918 confidential information that even root must not be able to access. | |
6919 Careful: All text will be in memory: | |
6920 - Don't use this for big files. | |
6921 - Recovery will be impossible! | |
6922 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and | |
6923 'swapfile' is set. | |
6924 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is | |
6925 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is | |
6926 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created. | |
6927 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|. | |
5763 | 6928 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it, |
6929 use the |:noswapfile| modifier. | |
7 | 6930 |
6931 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to | |
6932 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
6933 | |
6934 *'swapsync'* *'sws'* | |
6935 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync") | |
6936 global | |
6937 {not in Vi} | |
6938 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after | |
10 | 6939 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems. |
7 | 6940 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and |
6941 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work. | |
6942 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it, | |
6943 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some | |
6944 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system | |
6945 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default | |
6946 fsync(), which may work better on some systems. | |
36 | 6947 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file. |
7 | 6948 |
6949 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'* | |
6950 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "") | |
6951 global | |
6952 {not in Vi} | |
6953 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers. | |
6954 Possible values (comma separated list): | |
6955 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that | |
6956 contains the specified buffer (if there is one). | |
6957 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows. | |
6958 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when | |
6959 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is | |
6960 also used in all buffer related split commands, for | |
6961 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind". | |
825 | 6962 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab |
856 | 6963 pages. |
7 | 6964 split If included, split the current window before loading |
3153 | 6965 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors. |
6966 Otherwise: do not split, use current window. | |
1621 | 6967 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
6968 "split" when both are present. |
7 | 6969 |
410 | 6970 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'* |
6971 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000) | |
6972 local to buffer | |
6973 {not in Vi} | |
6974 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6975 feature} | |
419 | 6976 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the |
6977 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not | |
6978 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared. | |
410 | 6979 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one |
6980 long line. | |
6981 Set to zero to remove the limit. | |
6982 | |
7 | 6983 *'syntax'* *'syn'* |
6984 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty) | |
6985 local to buffer | |
6986 {not in Vi} | |
6987 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6988 feature} | |
6989 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless | |
6990 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off". | |
6991 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the | |
6992 b:current_syntax variable does). | |
6993 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is | |
782 | 6994 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file: |
6995 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~ | |
6996 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
6997 names. Example: | |
6998 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
6999 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax. | |
7000 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition, | |
7001 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear. | |
7002 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: > | |
7 | 7003 :set syntax=OFF |
7004 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the | |
7005 'filetype' option: > | |
7006 :set syntax=ON | |
7007 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the | |
7008 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument. | |
7009 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or | |
7010 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 7011 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 7012 |
699 | 7013 *'tabline'* *'tal'* |
677 | 7014 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty) |
674 | 7015 global |
7016 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7017 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
674 | 7018 feature} |
677 | 7019 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages |
7020 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default | |
681 | 7021 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info. |
677 | 7022 |
7023 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline' | |
688 | 7024 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in |
7025 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used | |
2572
ee53a39d5896
Last changes for the 7.3 release!
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2570
diff
changeset
|
7026 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different. |
677 | 7027 |
7028 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use | |
7029 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out | |
681 | 7030 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for |
7031 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels. | |
677 | 7032 |
7033 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others | |
7034 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows. | |
7035 | |
674 | 7036 |
699 | 7037 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'* |
7038 'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10) | |
7039 global | |
7040 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7041 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
699 | 7042 feature} |
7043 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line | |
7044 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage| | |
7045 | |
7046 | |
7047 *'tabstop'* *'ts'* | |
7 | 7048 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8) |
7049 local to buffer | |
7050 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see | |
7051 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option. | |
7052 | |
7053 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file | |
7054 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it). | |
7055 | |
7056 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim: | |
7057 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4 | |
7058 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim | |
1263 | 7059 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will |
7 | 7060 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters. |
7061 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use | |
7062 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The | |
7063 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed. | |
7064 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a | |
10 | 7065 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only |
7 | 7066 works when using Vim to edit the file. |
7067 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and | |
7068 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only) | |
7069 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have | |
7070 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this | |
7071 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is | |
7072 changed. | |
7073 | |
7074 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'* | |
7075 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on) | |
7076 global | |
7077 {not in Vi} | |
7078 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either | |
10 | 7079 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary |
7 | 7080 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search |
7081 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted. | |
7082 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that | |
7083 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the | |
7084 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off. | |
7085 | |
7086 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags | |
10 | 7087 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for |
7 | 7088 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When |
7089 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done. | |
7090 | |
7091 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line | |
7092 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: > | |
1621 | 7093 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/ |
7 | 7094 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>] |
7095 | |
7096 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the | |
7097 files listed in 'tags', and 'ignorecase' is set or a pattern is used | |
7098 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search. | |
7099 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only | |
7100 be found in the retry. | |
7101 | |
22 | 7102 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second, |
7 | 7103 linear search can be avoided for the 'ignorecase' case. Use a value |
7104 of '2' in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be | |
7105 case-fold sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in | |
7106 the command: "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
7107 5.x or higher (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
7108 for this as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
7109 to work. |
7 | 7110 |
7111 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match | |
7112 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags | |
7113 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off. | |
7114 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on | |
7115 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above | |
7116 must be included in the tags file. | |
7117 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g., | |
7118 command-line completion and ":help"). | |
7119 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions} | |
7120 | |
7121 *'taglength'* *'tl'* | |
7122 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0) | |
7123 global | |
7124 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters. | |
7125 | |
7126 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'* | |
7127 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7128 global | |
7129 {not in Vi} | |
824 | 7130 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that |
7131 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is. | |
7 | 7132 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7133 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7134 | |
7135 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433* | |
7136 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with | |
7137 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS") | |
7138 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7139 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To | |
7140 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash | |
7141 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes). | |
7142 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path | |
7143 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in | |
7144 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see | |
7145 |tags-option|. | |
7146 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in | |
2522
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7147 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7148 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7149 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7150 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7151 |+path_extra| feature} |
515 | 7152 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names |
7153 actually used. | |
7 | 7154 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag |
7155 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The | |
7156 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case | |
7157 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags| | |
7158 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7159 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7160 uses another default. | |
7161 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"} | |
7162 | |
7163 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'* | |
7164 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on) | |
7165 global | |
7166 {not in all versions of Vi} | |
7167 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or | |
7168 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the | |
7169 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or | |
7170 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified | |
7171 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry. | |
7172 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a | |
7173 mapping which should not change the tagstack. | |
7174 | |
7175 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531* | |
7176 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails: | |
7177 in the GUI: "builtin_gui" | |
7178 on Amiga: "amiga" | |
7179 on BeOS: "beos-ansi" | |
7180 on Mac: "mac-ansi" | |
7181 on MiNT: "vt52" | |
7182 on MS-DOS: "pcterm" | |
7183 on OS/2: "os2ansi" | |
7184 on Unix: "ansi" | |
7185 on VMS: "ansi" | |
7186 on Win 32: "win32") | |
7187 global | |
7188 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control | |
7189 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
7190 For example: > | |
7191 :set term=$TERM | |
7192 < See |termcap|. | |
7193 | |
7194 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'* | |
7195 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'* | |
7196 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm") | |
7197 global | |
7198 {not in Vi} | |
7199 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
7200 feature} | |
7201 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified | |
7202 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping | |
7203 that some languages (such as Arabic) require. | |
7204 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when | |
7205 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored. | |
7206 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that | |
7207 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically. | |
7208 This option is reset when the GUI is started. | |
7209 For further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
7210 | |
7211 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'* | |
7212 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with | |
7213 Macintosh GUI: "macroman") | |
7214 global | |
7215 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte| | |
7216 feature} | |
7217 {not in Vi} | |
7218 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character | |
7219 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For | |
4186 | 7220 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ( 'encoding' is used for the |
1152 | 7221 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then |
7222 'termencoding' should be "macroman". | |
7 | 7223 In the Win32 console version the default value is the console codepage |
7224 when it differs from the ANSI codepage. | |
7225 *E617* | |
7226 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been | |
7227 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8". | |
7228 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error | |
7229 message is shown. | |
7230 For the Win32 GUI 'termencoding' is not used for typed characters, | |
7231 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters. | |
7232 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option. | |
7233 This is the normal value. | |
7234 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See | |
7235 |encoding-table|. | |
7236 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or | |
7237 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you | |
7238 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters. | |
7239 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and | |
7240 want to edit a UTF-8 file: > | |
7241 :let &termencoding = &encoding | |
7242 :set encoding=utf-8 | |
7243 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8. | |
7244 | |
7245 *'terse'* *'noterse'* | |
7246 'terse' boolean (default off) | |
7247 global | |
7248 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message | |
7249 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being | |
7250 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi | |
7251 shortens a lot of messages} | |
7252 | |
7253 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'* | |
7254 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7255 global | |
7256 {not in Vi} | |
7257 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'. | |
7258 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is | |
7259 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is | |
7260 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty. | |
7261 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
7262 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7263 | |
7264 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'* | |
7265 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on, | |
7266 others: default off) | |
7267 local to buffer | |
7268 {not in Vi} | |
7269 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'. | |
7270 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is | |
7271 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to | |
7272 "unix". | |
7273 | |
7274 *'textwidth'* *'tw'* | |
7275 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0) | |
7276 local to buffer | |
7277 {not in Vi} | |
7278 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be | |
7279 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables | |
10 | 7280 this. 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. When |
7281 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also | |
7 | 7282 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. |
838 | 7283 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line. |
7 | 7284 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7285 | |
7286 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'* | |
7287 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "") | |
7288 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7289 {not in Vi} | |
7290 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
10 | 7291 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in |
7 | 7292 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by |
7293 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line | |
7294 length is 510 bytes. | |
3496
d1e4abe8342c
Fixed compatible mode in most runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3493
diff
changeset
|
7295 To obtain a file to be used here, check out this ftp site: |
d1e4abe8342c
Fixed compatible mode in most runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
3493
diff
changeset
|
7296 ftp://ftp.ox.ac.uk/pub/wordlists/ First get the README file. |
10 | 7297 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 7298 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
7299 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
7300 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7301 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7302 uses another default. | |
7303 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
7304 | |
7305 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'* | |
7306 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off) | |
7307 global | |
7308 {not in Vi} | |
7309 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator. | |
7310 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7311 | |
7312 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'* | |
7313 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on) | |
7314 global | |
7315 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'* | |
7316 'ttimeout' boolean (default off) | |
7317 global | |
7318 {not in Vi} | |
7319 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a | |
7320 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received: | |
7321 | |
7322 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~ | |
7323 off off do not time out | |
7324 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes | |
7325 off on time out on key codes | |
7326 | |
7327 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete | |
7328 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there | |
7329 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For | |
7330 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next | |
7331 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'. | |
7332 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for | |
7333 the next character to arrive. After that the already received | |
7334 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can | |
7335 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option. | |
7336 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause | |
7337 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits | |
7338 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start | |
7339 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have | |
7340 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key | |
7341 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and | |
7342 reset the 'timeout' option. | |
7343 | |
7344 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7345 | |
7346 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'* | |
7347 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000) | |
7348 global | |
7349 {not in all versions of Vi} | |
7350 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'* | |
7351 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1) | |
7352 global | |
7353 {not in Vi} | |
7354 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key | |
7355 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G | |
7356 when part of a command has been typed. | |
7357 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a | |
7358 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to | |
7359 a non-negative number. | |
7360 | |
7361 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~ | |
7362 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen' | |
7363 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen' | |
7364 | |
7365 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options | |
7366 tell so. A useful setting would be > | |
7367 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100 | |
7368 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after | |
7369 a tenth of a second). | |
7370 | |
7371 *'title'* *'notitle'* | |
7372 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
7373 global | |
7374 {not in Vi} | |
7375 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7376 feature} | |
7377 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of | |
7378 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to: | |
7379 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM | |
7380 Where: | |
7381 filename the name of the file being edited | |
7382 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off | |
7383 + indicates the file was modified | |
7384 = indicates the file is read-only | |
7385 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified | |
7386 (path) is the path of the file being edited | |
7387 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM" | |
7388 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles | |
7389 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and | |
7390 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and | |
7391 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap). | |
7392 *X11* | |
7393 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
7394 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11" | |
7395 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also | |
7396 works for the icon name |'icon'|. | |
7397 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title | |
7398 will not work (except in the GUI). | |
7399 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'. | |
7400 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then. | |
7401 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command: | |
7402 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY & | |
7403 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the | |
7404 title of the window should change back to what it should be after | |
7405 exiting Vim. | |
7406 | |
7407 *'titlelen'* | |
7408 'titlelen' number (default 85) | |
7409 global | |
7410 {not in Vi} | |
7411 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7412 feature} | |
7413 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window | |
10 | 7414 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is |
7415 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this. | |
7 | 7416 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But |
7417 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters | |
7418 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title | |
7419 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise, | |
7420 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used. | |
7421 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option. | |
7422 | |
7423 *'titleold'* | |
7424 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim") | |
7425 global | |
7426 {not in Vi} | |
7427 {only available when compiled with the |+title| | |
7428 feature} | |
7429 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the | |
7430 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or | |
7431 'titlestring' is not empty. | |
36 | 7432 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7433 security reasons. | |
7 | 7434 *'titlestring'* |
7435 'titlestring' string (default "") | |
7436 global | |
7437 {not in Vi} | |
7438 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7439 feature} | |
7440 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the | |
7441 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on. | |
7442 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently | |
7443 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a | |
7444 non-empty 't_ts' option). | |
7445 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
7446 be restored if possible |X11|. | |
7447 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be | |
7448 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. | |
7449 Example: > | |
7450 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p") | |
7451 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70 | |
7452 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right | |
7453 of the available space. | |
7454 Some people prefer to have the file name first: > | |
7455 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%) | |
7456 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file, | |
10 | 7457 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a |
7 | 7458 separating space only when needed. |
7459 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display | |
7460 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character). | |
7461 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} | |
7462 | |
7463 *'toolbar'* *'tb'* | |
7464 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips") | |
7465 global | |
7466 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and | |
7467 |+GUI_Photon|} | |
10 | 7468 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The |
7 | 7469 possible values are: |
7470 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons. | |
7471 text Toolbar buttons shown with text. | |
7472 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are | |
10 | 7473 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI} |
7 | 7474 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons. |
7475 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse | |
7476 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment. | |
7477 | |
7478 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the | |
7479 following: > | |
7480 :set tb=icons,text | |
7481 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They | |
7482 will show icons if both are requested. | |
7483 | |
7484 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if | |
7485 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable | |
7486 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: > | |
7487 :set guioptions-=T | |
7488 < Also see |gui-toolbar|. | |
7489 | |
7490 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'* | |
7491 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small") | |
7492 global | |
7493 {not in Vi} | |
7494 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI} | |
7495 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are: | |
7496 tiny Use tiny toolbar icons. | |
7497 small Use small toolbar icons (default). | |
7498 medium Use medium-sized toolbar icons. | |
7499 large Use large toolbar icons. | |
7500 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on | |
7501 the current theme. Common dimensions are large=32x32, medium=24x24, | |
7502 small=20x20 and tiny=16x16. | |
7503 | |
7504 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined | |
7505 by user preferences or the current theme is used. | |
7506 | |
7507 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'* | |
7508 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on) | |
7509 global | |
7510 {not in Vi} | |
7511 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones. | |
7512 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones. | |
7513 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for | |
7514 the change to take effect, for example: > | |
7515 :set notbi term=$TERM | |
7516 < See also |termcap|. | |
7517 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin | |
7518 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty | |
7519 xterm entries...). | |
7520 | |
7521 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'* | |
7522 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm, | |
7523 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or | |
7524 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in | |
7525 a DOS console) | |
7526 global | |
7527 {not in Vi} | |
7528 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to | |
7529 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line | |
7530 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple | |
7531 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region. | |
7532 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen | |
7533 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the | |
7534 mouse in an xterm and other terminals. | |
7535 | |
7536 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'* | |
7537 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term') | |
7538 global | |
7539 {not in Vi} | |
7540 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not | |
7541 available when compiled without |+mouse|} | |
7542 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized. | |
1213 | 7543 Currently these strings are valid: |
7 | 7544 *xterm-mouse* |
7545 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates | |
7546 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes: | |
7547 "s" = button state | |
7548 "c" = column plus 33 | |
7549 "r" = row plus 33 | |
5908 | 7550 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec", |
7551 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions. | |
7 | 7552 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the |
7553 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works | |
7554 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at | |
180 | 7555 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to |
7 | 7556 work. See below for how Vim detects this |
7557 automatically. | |
7558 *netterm-mouse* | |
7559 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates | |
7560 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers | |
7561 for the row and column. | |
7562 *dec-mouse* | |
7563 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a | |
7564 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[". | |
189 | 7565 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was |
7566 configured with "--enable-dec-locator". | |
7 | 7567 *jsbterm-mouse* |
7568 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling. | |
7569 *pterm-mouse* | |
7570 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling. | |
3224 | 7571 *urxvt-mouse* |
7572 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal. | |
5908 | 7573 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this |
7574 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit | |
7575 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2". | |
3750 | 7576 *sgr-mouse* |
7577 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled | |
5908 | 7578 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns |
7579 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with | |
7580 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style | |
7581 mouse codes. | |
7 | 7582 |
7583 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm| | |
5908 | 7584 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt| |
7585 |+mouse_sgr|. | |
7 | 7586 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always |
7587 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes | |
7588 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not | |
5908 | 7589 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict |
7590 with them). | |
7 | 7591 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is |
5908 | 7592 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", or "screen", and |
7593 'ttymouse' is not set already. | |
7594 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and | |
7595 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version | |
7596 number, more intelligent detection process runs. | |
7 | 7597 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be |
5908 | 7598 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if the xterm version is |
7599 277 or highter. | |
7600 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr" | |
7601 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: > | |
7 | 7602 :set t_RV= |
7603 < | |
7604 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'* | |
7605 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999) | |
7606 global | |
7607 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines | |
7608 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is | |
7609 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number, | |
7610 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying. | |
7611 | |
7612 *'ttytype'* *'tty'* | |
7613 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM) | |
7614 global | |
7615 Alias for 'term', see above. | |
7616 | |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7617 *'undodir'* *'udir'* |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7618 'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".") |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7619 global |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7620 {not in Vi} |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7621 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7622 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
7623 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format. |
2218
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
7624 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
7625 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~". |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
7626 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
7627 file, with path separators replaced with "%". |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7628 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7629 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7630 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7631 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7632 given, no further entry is used. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7633 See |undo-persistence|. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7634 |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
7635 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'* |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7636 'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off) |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7637 local to buffer |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7638 {not in Vi} |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7639 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7640 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7641 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7642 file on buffer read. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
7643 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'. |
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
7644 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|. |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7645 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7646 before a reload to be saved for undo. |
3920 | 7647 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted. |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
7648 |
7 | 7649 *'undolevels'* *'ul'* |
7650 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS, | |
7651 Win32 and OS/2) | |
5446 | 7652 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 7653 {not in Vi} |
7654 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information | |
7655 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used | |
7656 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory). | |
7657 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes | |
7658 itself: > | |
7659 set ul=0 | |
7660 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in | |
7661 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo. | |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
7662 Also see |undo-two-ways|. |
5446 | 7663 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the |
7664 current buffer: > | |
7665 setlocal ul=-1 | |
7 | 7666 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change. |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
7667 Also see |clear-undo|. |
7 | 7668 |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7669 *'undoreload'* *'ur'* |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7670 'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000) |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7671 global |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7672 {not in Vi} |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7673 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7674 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7675 Vim. |FileChangedShell| |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7676 The save only happens when this options is negative or when the number |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7677 of lines is smaller than the value of this option. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7678 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7679 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7680 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7681 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7682 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
7683 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory. |
7 | 7684 |
7685 *'updatecount'* *'uc'* | |
7686 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200) | |
7687 global | |
7688 {not in Vi} | |
7689 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to | |
7690 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on | |
7691 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting | |
7692 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly | |
7693 mode this option will be initialized to 10000. | |
7694 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|. | |
7695 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are | |
7696 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount' | |
7697 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted. | |
7698 Also see |'swapsync'|. | |
7699 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile" | |
7700 or "nowrite". | |
7701 | |
7702 *'updatetime'* *'ut'* | |
7703 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000) | |
7704 global | |
7705 {not in Vi} | |
7706 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be | |
7707 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the | |
7708 |CursorHold| autocommand event. | |
7709 | |
7710 *'verbose'* *'vbs'* | |
7711 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0) | |
7712 global | |
7713 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean | |
7714 verbose option} | |
7715 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing. | |
7716 Currently, these messages are given: | |
7717 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written. | |
7718 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed. | |
712 | 7719 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file. |
7 | 7720 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed. |
7721 >= 9 Every executed autocommand. | |
7722 >= 12 Every executed function. | |
7723 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded. | |
7724 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause. | |
7725 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters). | |
7726 | |
7727 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|. | |
7728 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command. | |
7729 | |
293 | 7730 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not |
7731 displayed. | |
7732 | |
7733 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'* | |
7734 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty) | |
7735 global | |
7736 {not in Vi} | |
7737 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name. | |
7738 When the file exists messages are appended. | |
7739 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made | |
2265
b7cb69ab616d
Added salt to blowfish encryption.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2250
diff
changeset
|
7740 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time. |
293 | 7741 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first. |
7742 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not | |
7743 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set. | |
7744 | |
7 | 7745 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'* |
7746 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32: | |
7747 "$VIM/vimfiles/view", | |
7748 for Unix: "~/.vim/view", | |
7749 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view" | |
7750 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view" | |
7751 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view") | |
7752 global | |
7753 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7754 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 7755 feature} |
7756 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|. | |
7757 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
7758 security reasons. | |
7759 | |
7760 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'* | |
7761 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor") | |
7762 global | |
7763 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7764 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 7765 feature} |
7766 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated | |
10 | 7767 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something: |
7 | 7768 word save and restore ~ |
7769 cursor cursor position in file and in window | |
7770 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
7771 fold options | |
7772 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
7773 global values for local options) | |
7774 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward | |
7775 slashes | |
7776 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when | |
7777 on Windows or DOS | |
7778 | |
7779 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files | |
7780 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, | |
7781 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. | |
7782 | |
7783 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528* | |
7784 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS, | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
7785 Windows and OS/2: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
7786 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
7787 for others: '100,<50,s10,h) |
7 | 7788 global |
7789 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7790 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo| |
7 | 7791 feature} |
7792 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written | |
10 | 7793 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma |
7 | 7794 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character |
7795 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string | |
7796 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular | |
7797 character is left out, then the default value is used for that | |
7798 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and | |
7799 the effect of their value. | |
7800 CHAR VALUE ~ | |
3224 | 7801 *viminfo-!* |
7 | 7802 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start |
7803 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase | |
7804 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis" | |
2607 | 7805 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be |
2642 | 7806 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item. |
3224 | 7807 *viminfo-quote* |
7 | 7808 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of |
7809 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a | |
7810 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the | |
7811 start of a comment! | |
3224 | 7812 *viminfo-%* |
7 | 7813 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is |
7814 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not | |
7815 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the | |
10 | 7816 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Buffers |
7 | 7817 without a file name and buffers for help files are not written |
7818 to the viminfo file. | |
23 | 7819 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum |
7820 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all | |
7821 buffers are stored. | |
3224 | 7822 *viminfo-'* |
7 | 7823 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks |
7824 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when | |
7825 'viminfo' is non-empty. | |
7826 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the | |
7827 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file. | |
3224 | 7828 *viminfo-/* |
7 | 7829 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be |
10 | 7830 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute |
7 | 7831 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of |
7832 'history' is used. | |
3224 | 7833 *viminfo-:* |
7 | 7834 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be |
10 | 7835 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 7836 *viminfo-<* |
7 | 7837 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then |
7838 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are | |
7839 saved. '"' is the old name for this item. | |
7840 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte. | |
3224 | 7841 *viminfo-@* |
7 | 7842 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be |
10 | 7843 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 7844 *viminfo-c* |
7 | 7845 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the |
7846 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current | |
233 | 7847 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|. |
3224 | 7848 *viminfo-f* |
7 | 7849 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0 |
7850 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when | |
10 | 7851 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current |
7 | 7852 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo"). |
3224 | 7853 *viminfo-h* |
7 | 7854 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo |
7855 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch" | |
7856 has been used since the last search command. | |
3224 | 7857 *viminfo-n* |
7 | 7858 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow |
7859 the 'n'. Must be the last one! If the "-i" argument was | |
7860 given when starting Vim, that file name overrides the one | |
7861 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are expanded | |
7862 when opening the file, not when setting the option. | |
3224 | 7863 *viminfo-r* |
7 | 7864 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next |
7865 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each | |
7866 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be | |
7867 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you | |
7868 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can | |
7869 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is | |
7870 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50 | |
7871 characters. | |
3224 | 7872 *viminfo-s* |
7 | 7873 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are |
7874 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default | |
7875 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text. | |
7876 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit. | |
7877 | |
7878 Example: > | |
7879 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo | |
7880 < | |
7881 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you | |
7882 edited. | |
7883 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be | |
7884 remembered. | |
7885 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped. | |
7886 :0 Command-line history will not be saved. | |
7887 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo". | |
7888 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used, | |
7889 that is, save all of the search history, and also the | |
7890 previous search and substitute patterns. | |
7891 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back. | |
7892 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored. | |
7893 | |
7894 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to | |
7895 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically. | |
7896 | |
7897 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
7898 security reasons. | |
7899 | |
7900 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'* | |
7901 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "") | |
7902 global | |
7903 {not in Vi} | |
7904 {not available when compiled without the | |
7905 |+virtualedit| feature} | |
7906 A comma separated list of these words: | |
7907 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode. | |
7908 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode. | |
7909 all Allow virtual editing in all modes. | |
772 | 7910 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line |
782 | 7911 |
7 | 7912 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is |
1263 | 7913 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end |
7 | 7914 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and |
7915 editing a table. | |
772 | 7916 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just |
7917 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more | |
7918 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line | |
7919 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also | |
782 | 7920 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move |
7921 the cursor after the last character. Use with care! | |
5220 | 7922 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not |
782 | 7923 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left! |
5220 | 7924 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line. |
772 | 7925 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will |
7926 not get a warning for it. | |
7 | 7927 |
7928 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep* | |
7929 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off) | |
7930 global | |
7931 {not in Vi} | |
7932 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the | |
7933 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted, | |
7934 use ":set vb t_vb=". | |
7935 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You | |
7936 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|. | |
7937 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display | |
7938 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f", | |
7939 where 40 is the time in msec. | |
7940 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash. | |
7941 Also see 'errorbells'. | |
7942 | |
7943 *'warn'* *'nowarn'* | |
7944 'warn' boolean (default on) | |
7945 global | |
7946 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer | |
7947 has been changed. | |
7948 | |
7949 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'* | |
7950 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off) | |
7951 global | |
7952 {not in Vi} | |
667 | 7953 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option. |
7 | 7954 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x. |
7955 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and | |
7956 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running. | |
7957 | |
7958 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'* | |
7959 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "") | |
7960 global | |
7961 {not in Vi} | |
7962 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the | |
7963 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in | |
7964 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys: | |
7965 char key mode ~ | |
7966 b <BS> Normal and Visual | |
7967 s <Space> Normal and Visual | |
712 | 7968 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended) |
7969 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended) | |
7 | 7970 < <Left> Normal and Visual |
7971 > <Right> Normal and Visual | |
7972 ~ "~" Normal | |
7973 [ <Left> Insert and Replace | |
7974 ] <Right> Insert and Replace | |
7975 For example: > | |
7976 :set ww=<,>,[,] | |
7977 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used. | |
7978 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change | |
7979 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h" | |
7980 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This | |
7981 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and | |
7982 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping | |
7983 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the | |
7984 cursor. | |
714 | 7985 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a |
7986 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl", | |
7987 "yl" etc. work normally. | |
7 | 7988 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7989 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7990 | |
7991 *'wildchar'* *'wc'* | |
7992 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E) | |
7993 global | |
7994 {not in Vi} | |
7995 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the | |
7996 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'. | |
1621 | 7997 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 7998 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See |
7999 'wildcharm' for that. | |
8000 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: > | |
8001 :set wc=<Esc> | |
8002 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
8003 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
8004 | |
8005 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'* | |
8006 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0)) | |
8007 global | |
8008 {not in Vi} | |
8009 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is | |
233 | 8010 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line |
8011 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally | |
7 | 8012 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that |
8013 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: > | |
8014 :set wcm=<C-Z> | |
1621 | 8015 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z> |
7 | 8016 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N. |
8017 | |
8018 *'wildignore'* *'wig'* | |
8019 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "") | |
8020 global | |
8021 {not in Vi} | |
8022 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8023 feature} | |
8024 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these | |
3682 | 8025 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or |
8026 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and | |
8027 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this. | |
7 | 8028 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. |
8029 Also see 'suffixes'. | |
8030 Example: > | |
8031 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj | |
8032 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
8033 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
8034 uses another default. | |
8035 | |
2652 | 8036 |
2662 | 8037 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'* |
2652 | 8038 'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off) |
8039 global | |
8040 {not in Vi} | |
8041 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories. | |
4242 | 8042 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set. |
2652 | 8043 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which |
8044 happens when there are special characters. | |
8045 | |
8046 | |
7 | 8047 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'* |
8048 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off) | |
8049 global | |
8050 {not in Vi} | |
8051 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu| | |
8052 feature} | |
8053 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced | |
8054 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion, | |
8055 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the | |
8056 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is | |
8057 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or | |
8058 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match. | |
8059 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is | |
8060 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode. | |
4159 | 8061 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|. |
7 | 8062 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on |
8063 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls | |
8064 as needed. | |
8065 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used | |
8066 for selecting a completion. | |
8067 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special | |
8068 meanings: | |
8069 | |
8070 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N) | |
8071 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a | |
8072 subdirectory or submenu. | |
8073 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a | |
8074 dot: move into a submenu. | |
8075 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into | |
8076 parent directory or parent menu. | |
8077 | |
8078 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|. | |
8079 | |
8080 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead | |
8081 of selecting a different match, use this: > | |
8082 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left> | |
8083 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right> | |
8084 < | |
8085 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match | |
8086 |hl-WildMenu|. | |
8087 | |
8088 *'wildmode'* *'wim'* | |
8089 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full") | |
8090 global | |
8091 {not in Vi} | |
8092 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with | |
10 | 8093 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each |
1152 | 8094 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The |
7 | 8095 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar', |
8096 The second part for the second use, etc. | |
8097 These are the possible values for each part: | |
8098 "" Complete only the first match. | |
8099 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match, | |
8100 the original string is used and then the first match | |
8101 again. | |
8102 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't | |
8103 result in a longer string, use the next part. | |
8104 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is | |
8105 enabled. | |
8106 "list" When more than one match, list all matches. | |
8107 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8108 complete first match. | |
8109 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8110 complete till longest common string. | |
8111 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases. | |
8112 | |
8113 Examples: > | |
8114 :set wildmode=full | |
233 | 8115 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) > |
7 | 8116 :set wildmode=longest,full |
8117 < Complete longest common string, then each full match > | |
8118 :set wildmode=list:full | |
8119 < List all matches and complete each full match > | |
8120 :set wildmode=list,full | |
8121 < List all matches without completing, then each full match > | |
8122 :set wildmode=longest,list | |
8123 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives. | |
1621 | 8124 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 8125 |
40 | 8126 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'* |
8127 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "") | |
8128 global | |
8129 {not in Vi} | |
8130 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8131 feature} | |
8132 A list of words that change how command line completion is done. | |
8133 Currently only one word is allowed: | |
8134 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of | |
856 | 8135 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match |
40 | 8136 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are: |
8137 d #define | |
8138 f function | |
8139 Also see |cmdline-completion|. | |
8140 | |
7 | 8141 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'* |
8142 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu") | |
8143 global | |
8144 {not in Vi} | |
8145 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI} | |
8146 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT | |
8147 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the | |
8148 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and | |
8149 entering special characters. This option tells what to do: | |
8150 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be | |
8151 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be | |
8152 done with the |:simalt| command. | |
8153 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key | |
8154 combinations cannot be mapped. | |
8155 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu | |
10 | 8156 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other |
7 | 8157 keys can be mapped. |
8158 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT | |
8159 key is never used for the menu. | |
36 | 8160 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will |
8161 select the menu, unless it has been mapped. | |
7 | 8162 |
164 | 8163 *'window'* *'wi'* |
8164 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1) | |
8165 global | |
8166 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window, | |
8167 use 'lines' for that. | |
179 | 8168 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the |
8169 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll | |
8170 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one. | |
164 | 8171 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll |
8172 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines. | |
8173 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than | |
8174 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1. | |
8175 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines} | |
8176 | |
7 | 8177 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591* |
8178 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1) | |
8179 global | |
8180 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8181 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8182 feature} |
8183 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard | |
10 | 8184 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the |
1621 | 8185 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the |
8186 cost of the height of other windows. | |
8187 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing. | |
8188 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen. | |
8189 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback | |
8190 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4" | |
8191 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done, | |
8192 using the |VimEnter| event: > | |
8193 au VimEnter * set winheight=999 | |
8194 < Minimum value is 1. | |
8195 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the | |
7 | 8196 height of the current window. |
8197 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set | |
8198 the minimal height for other windows. | |
8199 | |
8200 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'* | |
8201 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off) | |
8202 local to window | |
8203 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8204 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8205 feature} |
8206 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8207 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the |
8208 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|. | |
7 | 8209 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8210 | |
782 | 8211 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'* |
8212 'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off) | |
8213 local to window | |
8214 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8215 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
782 | 8216 feature} |
8217 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8218 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. |
782 | 8219 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8220 | |
7 | 8221 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'* |
8222 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1) | |
8223 global | |
8224 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8225 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8226 feature} |
8227 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8228 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8229 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a | |
8230 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when | |
8231 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.) | |
8232 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window. | |
8233 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8234 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8235 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable. | |
8236 | |
8237 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'* | |
8238 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1) | |
8239 global | |
8240 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8241 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 8242 feature} |
8243 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8244 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8245 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just | |
8246 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one | |
8247 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere | |
8248 to go.) | |
8249 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window. | |
8250 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8251 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8252 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable. | |
8253 | |
8254 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592* | |
8255 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20) | |
8256 global | |
8257 {not in Vi} | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8258 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 8259 feature} |
8260 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard | |
8261 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If | |
8262 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of | |
8263 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window | |
8264 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing. | |
8265 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the | |
8266 width of the current window. | |
8267 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set | |
8268 the minimal width for other windows. | |
8269 | |
8270 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'* | |
8271 'wrap' boolean (default on) | |
8272 local to window | |
8273 {not in Vi} | |
8274 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text | |
8275 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that. | |
8276 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and | |
10 | 8277 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap |
8278 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is | |
7 | 8279 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll |
8280 horizontally. | |
8281 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See | |
8282 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary. | |
8283 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: > | |
8284 :set sidescroll=5 | |
8285 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:> | |
8286 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8287 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8288 on. |
7 | 8289 |
8290 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'* | |
8291 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0) | |
8292 local to buffer | |
8293 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping | |
8294 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted | |
8295 and inserting continues on the next line. | |
8296 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause | |
8297 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible. | |
8298 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used. | |
8299 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently | |
8300 and less usefully} | |
8301 | |
8302 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'* | |
8303 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385* | |
8304 global | |
500 | 8305 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and |
8306 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes. | |
7 | 8307 |
8308 *'write'* *'nowrite'* | |
8309 'write' boolean (default on) | |
8310 global | |
8311 {not in Vi} | |
8312 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed. | |
8313 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are | |
10 | 8314 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line |
7 | 8315 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires |
8316 writing a temporary file. | |
8317 | |
8318 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'* | |
8319 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off) | |
8320 global | |
8321 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override. | |
8322 | |
8323 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'* | |
8324 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off | |
8325 otherwise) | |
8326 global | |
8327 {not in Vi} | |
8328 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after | |
8329 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is | |
3513 | 8330 also on. |
8331 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write | |
8332 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
8333 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset | |
8334 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write | |
8335 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful). | |
8336 See |backup-table| for another explanation. | |
7 | 8337 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. |
8338 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is | |
8339 set. | |
8340 | |
8341 *'writedelay'* *'wd'* | |
8342 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0) | |
8343 global | |
8344 {not in Vi} | |
8345 The number of microseconds to wait for each character sent to the | |
8346 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by | |
8347 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes. | |
8348 | |
8349 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: |